US20040235816A1 - Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them - Google Patents

Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20040235816A1
US20040235816A1 US10/870,274 US87027404A US2004235816A1 US 20040235816 A1 US20040235816 A1 US 20040235816A1 US 87027404 A US87027404 A US 87027404A US 2004235816 A1 US2004235816 A1 US 2004235816A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
methyl
methylsulfonyl
chlorophenyl
azetidine
methylene
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US10/870,274
Inventor
Daniel Achard
Herve Bouchard
Jean Bouquerel
Marc Capet
Serg Grisoni
Jean-Luc Malleron
Serg Mignani
Augustin Hittinger
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Aventis Pharma SA
Original Assignee
Aventis Pharma SA
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Priority claimed from FR9811342A external-priority patent/FR2783246B1/en
Application filed by Aventis Pharma SA filed Critical Aventis Pharma SA
Priority to US10/870,274 priority Critical patent/US20040235816A1/en
Publication of US20040235816A1 publication Critical patent/US20040235816A1/en
Priority to US11/420,238 priority patent/US20060270649A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D401/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom
    • C07D401/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings
    • C07D401/06Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, having nitrogen atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, at least one ring being a six-membered ring with only one nitrogen atom containing two hetero rings linked by a carbon chain containing only aliphatic carbon atoms
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P1/00Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system
    • A61P1/08Drugs for disorders of the alimentary tract or the digestive system for nausea, cinetosis or vertigo; Antiemetics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P11/00Drugs for disorders of the respiratory system
    • A61P11/06Antiasthmatics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P21/00Drugs for disorders of the muscular or neuromuscular system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/04Centrally acting analgesics, e.g. opioids
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/06Antimigraine agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/08Antiepileptics; Anticonvulsants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/14Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abnormal movements, e.g. chorea, dyskinesia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/14Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abnormal movements, e.g. chorea, dyskinesia
    • A61P25/16Anti-Parkinson drugs
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/18Antipsychotics, i.e. neuroleptics; Drugs for mania or schizophrenia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/24Antidepressants
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/28Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating neurodegenerative disorders of the central nervous system, e.g. nootropic agents, cognition enhancers, drugs for treating Alzheimer's disease or other forms of dementia
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P25/00Drugs for disorders of the nervous system
    • A61P25/30Drugs for disorders of the nervous system for treating abuse or dependence
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P27/00Drugs for disorders of the senses
    • A61P27/02Ophthalmic agents
    • A61P27/06Antiglaucoma agents or miotics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P3/00Drugs for disorders of the metabolism
    • A61P3/04Anorexiants; Antiobesity agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/04Antibacterial agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P31/00Antiinfectives, i.e. antibiotics, antiseptics, chemotherapeutics
    • A61P31/12Antivirals
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P33/00Antiparasitic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P37/00Drugs for immunological or allergic disorders
    • A61P37/02Immunomodulators
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P5/00Drugs for disorders of the endocrine system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P9/00Drugs for disorders of the cardiovascular system
    • A61P9/02Non-specific cardiovascular stimulants, e.g. drugs for syncope, antihypotensives
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D205/00Heterocyclic compounds containing four-membered rings with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom
    • C07D205/02Heterocyclic compounds containing four-membered rings with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom not condensed with other rings
    • C07D205/06Heterocyclic compounds containing four-membered rings with one nitrogen atom as the only ring hetero atom not condensed with other rings having one double bond between ring members or between a ring member and a non-ring member
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D409/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms
    • C07D409/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing two hetero rings
    • C07D409/06Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing two hetero rings linked by a carbon chain containing only aliphatic carbon atoms
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D409/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms
    • C07D409/14Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms containing three or more hetero rings
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07DHETEROCYCLIC COMPOUNDS
    • C07D417/00Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00
    • C07D417/02Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00 containing two hetero rings
    • C07D417/06Heterocyclic compounds containing two or more hetero rings, at least one ring having nitrogen and sulfur atoms as the only ring hetero atoms, not provided for by group C07D415/00 containing two hetero rings linked by a carbon chain containing only aliphatic carbon atoms

Definitions

  • the present invention relates to azetidine derivatives of formula:
  • R represents a chain
  • R 1 represents a methyl or ethyl radical
  • R 2 represents either an aromatic chosen from phenyl, naphthyl or indenyl, these aromatics being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more halogens, alkyl, alkoxy, —CO-alk, hydroxyl, —COOR 5 , formyl, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethylsulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, nitro, —NR 6 R 7 , —CO—NH—NR 6 R 7 , —N(alk)COOR 8 , cyano, —CONHR 9 , —CO—NR 16 R 17 , alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, —O-alk-NR 12 R 13 or alkylthioalkyl or a heteroaromatic chosen from the benzofuryl, benzothiazolyl, benzothienyl, benzoxazolyl, chromanyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuryl, 2,3-di
  • R 3 and R 4 which are identical or different, represent either an aromatic chosen from phenyl, naphthyl or indenyl, these aromatics being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more halogens, alkyl, alkoxy, formyl, hydroxyl, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, —CO-alk, cyano, —COOR 5 , —CONR 10 R 11 , —CO—NH—NR 6 R 7 , alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-NR 6 R 7 or alkylthioalkyl; or a heteroaromatic chosen from benzofuryl, benzothiazolyl, benzothienyl, benzoxazolyl, chromanyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuryl, 2,3-dihydrobenzothienyl, furyl, isochromanyl, isoquinolyl, pyrrolyl, quino
  • R 5 is an alkyl or phenyl radical which is optionally substituted with one or more halogen atoms
  • R 6 and R 7 which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl, —COOalk, cycloalkyl, alkylcycloalkyl, -alk-O-alk or hydroxyalkyl radical or alternatively R 6 and R 7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk, —CO-alk-NR 14 R 15 , oxo, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-O-alk or —CO—NH 2 radicals,
  • R 8 represents an alkyl radical
  • R 9 represents a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or an alkyl radical substituted with a dialkylamino, phenyl, cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with —COOalk) or a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing one or more heteroatoms chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl radicals,
  • R 10 and R 11 which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or alternatively R 10 and R 11 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl radical,
  • R 12 and R 13 which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or cycloalkyl radical or alternatively R 12 and R 13 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR 14 R 15 radical or a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing a heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen,
  • R 14 and R 15 which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or —COOalk radical
  • R 16 and R 17 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen,
  • R′ represents a hydrogen atom or a —CO-alk radical
  • alk represents an alkyl or alkylene radical
  • alkyl and alkylene radicals and portions and the alkoxy radicals and portions are in the form of a straight or branched chain and contain 1 to 6 carbon atoms.
  • alkyl radicals there may be mentioned methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, sec-butyl, iso-butyl, tert-butyl, pentyl and hexyl radicals.
  • alkoxy radicals there may be mentioned methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, iso-propoxy, n-butoxy, iso-butoxy, sec-butoxy, tert-butoxy and pentyloxy radicals.
  • halogen comprises chlorine, fluorine, bromine and iodine.
  • R 2 and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent independently a substituted phenyl, the latter is preferably mono-, di- or trisubstituted.
  • R 6 and R 7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle
  • the latter is preferably an azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidyl, morpholinyl, imidazolyl, thiomorpholinyl or furyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with an alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-O-alk, —CONH 2 , —COalk, —COOalk, oxo, —CSNHalk, —CONHalk or —CO-alk-NR 14 R 15 radical and, in particular, with a methyl, ethyl, propyl, isobutyl, acetyl, N,N-dimethylaminomethylcarbonyl, methyloxycarbonyl, methylcarbamoyl, methylthiocarbamo
  • R 10 and R 11 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, the latter is preferably an azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidyl, morpholinyl or thiomorpholinyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with an alkyl.
  • R 12 and R 13 form together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle
  • the latter is preferably an azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidyl, morpholinyl or thiomorpholinyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with an alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR 14 R 15 radical or a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing a heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and, in particular, with a thiomorpholinyl radical.
  • R 16 and R 17 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, the latter is preferably a piperidyl ring.
  • R 9 represents an alkyl radical substituted with a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing one or more heteroatoms chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, the latter is preferably a pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuryl, morpholinyl or pyrrolyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl radicals.
  • the compounds of formula (I) may be provided in the form of enantiomers and diastereoisomers. These optical isomers and mixtures thereof form part of the invention.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 have the same meanings as in formula (I) and R′′ represents a hydroxyl, methanesulfonyloxy or acetyloxy radical.
  • This dehydration is carried out by any method known to persons skilled in the art which makes it possible to dehydrate an alcohol or one of its derivatives in order to obtain the corresponding alkene.
  • derivatives are used for which R′′ is a methanesulfonyloxy or acetyloxy radical obtained from the corresponding derivative for which R′′ is a hydroxyl radical by the action of methanesulfonyl chloride or acetyl chloride, in an inert solvent such as pyridine, tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane or chloroform for example), at a temperature of between 5° C. and 20° C.
  • a base such as an alkali metal hydroxide (sodium hydroxide for example), an alkali metal carbonate (sodium or potassium carbonate for example), an amine such as a trialkylamine (triethylamine for example), 4-dimethylaminopyridine, diaza-1,8-bicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene, at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture.
  • a base such as an alkali metal hydroxide (sodium hydroxide for example), an alkali metal carbonate (sodium or potassium carbonate for example), an amine such as a trialkylamine (triethylamine for example), 4-dimethylaminopyridine, diaza-1,8-bicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene, at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture.
  • the methanesulfonyloxy and the acetyloxy may be isolated or otherwise
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R represents a chain (B) in which R′ is a hydrogen atom may be prepared by reacting the derivative R 1 SO 2 CH 2 R 2 (II) for which R 1 and R 2 have the same meanings as in formula (I) with an azetidinone of formula:
  • the procedure is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as an ether (tetrahydrofuran for example), in the presence of a strong base such as lithium diisopropylamide, potassium tert-butoxide or n-butyllithium, at a temperature of between ⁇ 70° C. and ⁇ 15° C.
  • an inert solvent such as an ether (tetrahydrofuran for example)
  • a strong base such as lithium diisopropylamide, potassium tert-butoxide or n-butyllithium
  • Hal represents a halogen atom and, preferably, chlorine, bromine or iodine
  • R 1 and R 2 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • reaction (a) is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as dimethylformamide or a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol, at a temperature of between 20 and 30° C.
  • an inert solvent such as dimethylformamide or a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol
  • reaction (b) is carried out by any known method which makes it possible to oxidize a sulfur-containing derivative without affecting the rest of the molecule such as the methods described by M. HUDLICKY, Oxidations in Organic Chemistry, ACS Monograph, 186, 252-263 (1990).
  • the procedure is carried out by the action of an organic peroxy acid or a salt of such a peroxy acid (peroxycarboxylic or peroxysulfonic acids, especially peroxybenzoic acid, 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid, 4-nitroperoxybenzoic acid, peroxyacetic acid, trifluoroperoxyacetic acid, peroxyformic acid or monoperoxyphthalic acid) or in organic peracids or a salt of such an acid (for example periodic or persulfuric acid), in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (chloroform or dichloromethane for example), at a temperature of between 0 and 25° C.
  • a peroxy acid peroxycarboxylic or peroxysulfonic acids, especially peroxybenzoic acid, 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid, 4-nitroperoxybenzoic acid, peroxyacetic acid, trifluoroperoxyacetic acid, peroxyformic acid or monoperoxyphthalic acid
  • hydrogen peroxide or a periodate in an inert solvent such as 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example), water or a mixture of these solvents, at a temperature of between 0 and 20° C. It is also possible to carry out the procedure using tert-butyl hydroperoxide in the presence of titanium tetraisopropoxide in a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example) or a water-alcohol mixture, at a temperature close to 25° C.
  • an inert solvent such as 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example)
  • water or a mixture of these solvents at a temperature of between 0 and 20° C.
  • oxone R potassium peroxymonosulfate
  • a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol methanol or ethanol for example
  • water acetic acid or sulfuric acid
  • the reaction (c) is preferably carried out in an inert solvent such as a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example), at a temperature of between 20° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • an inert solvent such as a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example)
  • the derivatives of formula (IV) are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described in the examples.
  • the methylated derivative or the corresponding alcohol is halogenated using a halogenating agent such as hydrobromic acid, in acetic acid, at a temperature close to 20° C. or N-bromo- or chlorosuccinimide in the presence of benzoyl peroxide, in an inert solvent such as tetrachloromethane, at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • a halogenating agent such as hydrobromic acid, in acetic acid, at a temperature close to 20° C. or N-bromo- or chlorosuccinimide in the presence of benzoyl peroxide, in an inert solvent such as tetrachloromethane, at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • the methylated derivatives or the corresponding alcohols are commercially available or may be obtained according to the methods described by BRINE G. A. et
  • the azetidinones of formula (III) may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al., J. Heterocycl. Chem., 271 (1994) or DAVE P. R., J. Org. Chem., 61, 5453 (1996) and in the examples.
  • the procedure is generally carried out according to the following reaction scheme:
  • R 3 and R 4 have the same meanings as in formula (I) and X represents a chlorine or bromine atom.
  • step A the procedure is preferably carried out in an inert solvent such as a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (ethanol or methanol for example), optionally in the presence of an alkali metal hydroxide, at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • an inert solvent such as a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (ethanol or methanol for example)
  • an alkali metal hydroxide at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • step B the reduction is generally carried out using lithium aluminum hydride, in tetrahydrofuran at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • step C the procedure is preferably carried out in an inert solvent such as a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (ethanol or methanol for example) in the presence of sodium hydrogen carbonate, at a temperature of between 20° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • an inert solvent such as a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (ethanol or methanol for example) in the presence of sodium hydrogen carbonate, at a temperature of between 20° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • step D the oxidation is preferably carried out in DMSO, using the sulfurtrioxide-pyridine complex, at a temperature close to 20° C. or using dimethyl sulfoxide, in the presence of oxalyl chloride and triethylamine, at a temperature of between ⁇ 70 and ⁇ 50° C.
  • step E the procedure is carried out according to the method described by GRISAR M. et al., in J. Med. Chem., 885 (1973).
  • the magnesium compound of the brominated derivative is formed and then the nitrile is reacted, in an ether such as ethyl ether, at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • an ether such as ethyl ether
  • the intermediate imine is reduced in situ with sodium borohydride at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • R 3 —CO—R 4 derivatives are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described by KUNDER N. G. et al. J. Chem. Soc. Perkin Trans 1, 2815 (1997); MORENO-MARRAS M., Eur. J. Med. Chem., 23 (5) 477 (1988); SKINNER et al., J. Med. Chem., 1A (6) 546 (1971); HURN N. K., Tet. Lett., M (52) 9453 (1995); MEDICI A. et al., Tet. Lett., 24 (28) 2901 (1983); RIECKE R. D. et al., J. Org.
  • R 3 Br derivatives are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described by BRANDSMA L. et al., Synth. Comm., 20 (11) 1697 and 3153 (1990); LEMAIRE M. et al., Synth. Comm., 24 (1) 95 (1994); GODA H. et al., Synthesis, 9 849 (1992); BAEUERLE P. et al., J. Chem. Soc. Perkin Trans 2, 489 (1993).
  • R 4 CN derivatives are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described by BOUYSSOU P. et al., J. Het. Chem., 29 (4) 895 (1992); SUZUKI N. et al., J. Chem. Soc. Chem. Comm., 1523 (1984); MARBURG S. et al., J. Het. Chem., 17 1333 (1980); PERCEC V. et al., J. Org. Chem. 60 (21) 6895 (1995).
  • R 1 and R 2 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in the presence of a base such as an alkali metal carbonate (potassium carbonate for example), in an inert solvent such as acetonitrile, at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • a base such as an alkali metal carbonate (potassium carbonate for example)
  • an inert solvent such as acetonitrile
  • the derivatives of formula (VII) may be obtained by hydrolysis of a derivative of formula:
  • R 1 and R 2 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out using hydrochloric acid, in an inert solvent such as an ether (dioxane for example), at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • an inert solvent such as an ether (dioxane for example)
  • the derivatives of formula (VIII) are obtained by reacting vinyl chloroformate with a corresponding compound of formula (1) for [lacuna]
  • R represents a chain of formula (B)
  • R′ represents a hydroxyl radical
  • R 3 and R 4 are phenyl radicals, in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane or chloroform for example), at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R is a chain (B) in which R′ is a —CO-alk radical may be prepared by reacting a halide Hal-CO-alk in which Hal represents a halogen atom and, preferably, a chlorine atom and alk represents an alkyl radical with a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R is a chain (B) in which R′ is a hydrogen atom.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane or chloroform for example), at a temperature of between ⁇ 50° C. and 20° C., in the presence of n-butyllithium.
  • an inert solvent such as tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane or chloroform for example
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —NR 6 R 7 in which R 6 and R 7 each represent a hydrogen atom may also be prepared by reducing a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with nitro.
  • This reaction is carried out by any known method which makes it possible to reduce a nitro to an amino without affecting the rest of the molecule.
  • iron is used in the presence of hydrochloric acid in a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol such as ethanol, at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents an aromatic or heteroaromatic substituted with —COHNR 9 and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CONR 10 R 11 may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —COOR 5 for which R 5 is alkyl or phenyl optionally substituted with halogens with respectively an amine H 2 NR 9 or HNR 10 R 11 for which R 9 , R 10 and R 11 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane or chloroform for example) or a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example), at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture.
  • a chlorinated solvent dichloromethane or chloroform for example
  • a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol methanol or ethanol for example
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents an aromatic substituted with hydroxyl and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with hydroxyl may also be prepared by hydrolysis of a corresponding compound of formula (1) for which R 2 represents an aromatic substituted with alkoxy and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with alkoxy.
  • This reaction is carried out by any method of hydrolyzing an alkoxy to a hydroxyl without affecting the rest of the molecule.
  • the hydrolysis is carried out using boron tribromide, in a chlorinated solvent such as dichloromethane, at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents an aromatic substituted with —NR 6 R 7 for which R 6 represents an alkyl radical and R 7 represents a hydrogen atom may also be prepared by deprotecting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 represents an aromatic substituted with an —N(alk)COOR 8 in which R 8 represents a tert-butyl radical.
  • This reaction is generally carried out using hydrochloric acid, in a solvent such as dioxane at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • R represents a chain C ⁇ C(SO 2 R 1 )R′ 2 or C(OR′)CH(SO 2 R 1 )R′ 2 , R 1 , R′ 2 , R′ 3 and R′ 4 have the same meanings as the substituents R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 of formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R′ 2 , R′ 3 and R′ 4 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with carboxyl, using a derivative of formula R 5 OH for which R 5 is alkyl or phenyl optionally substituted with one or more halogens.
  • R 5 is alkyl
  • this reaction is generally carried out in the presence of an inorganic acid (sulfuric acid for example), at a temperature of between 20° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • an inorganic acid sulfuric acid for example
  • this reaction is preferably carried out in the presence of a carbodiimide (1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide or N,N′-dicyclohexylcarbodiimide for example)
  • an inert solvent such as an imide (dimethylformamide) or a chlorinated solvent (methylene chloride, 1,2-dichloroethane or chloroform for example
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with alkylthioalkyl may also be prepared by reaction of a derivative of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C ⁇ C(SO 2 R 1 )R′ 2 or C(OR′)CH(SO 2 R 1 )R′ 2 , R′, R 1 , R′ 2 , R′ 3 and R′ 4 have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R′ 2 , R′ 3 and R′ 4 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with haloalkyl with sodium alkylthiolate.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as an amide (dimethylformamide for example), at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • an inert solvent such as an amide (dimethylformamide for example)
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic substituted with hydroxyalkyl in which the alkyl contains one carbon atom may also be prepared by reducing a compound of formula (I) for which at least one of the substituents R 2 , R 3 and R 4 represents an aromatic substituted with formyl.
  • This reaction is generally carried out using sodium borohydride, in a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example), at a temperature close to 0° C.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 3 and/or R 4 represents an aromatic substituted with -alk-NR 6 R 7 for which alk is an alkyl containing one carbon atom may also be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (I) for which at least one of the substituents R 3 and R 4 represents an aromatic substituted with formyl with an amine HNR 6 R 7 in which R 6 and R 7 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloroethane for example), at a temperature close to 20° C. in the presence of sodium triacetoxyborohydride or sodium cyanoborohydride.
  • an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloroethane for example)
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CONHR 9 and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represents an aromatic or heteroaromatic substituted with —CO—NR 10 R 11 may also be prepared by reacting a derivative of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C ⁇ C(SO 2 R 1 )R′ 2 or C(OR′)CH(SO 2 R 1 )R′ 2 , R′, R 1 , R′ 2 , R′ 3 and R′ 4 have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R′ 2 , R′ 3 and R′ 4 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with carboxyl with respectively an amine H 2 NR 9 or HNR 10 R 11 in which R 9 , R 10 and R 11 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is preferably carried out in the presence of a condensing agent which is used in peptide chemistry such as a carbodiimide (for example 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide or N,N′-dicyclohexylcarbodiimide) or N,N′-carbonyldiimidazole, in an inert solvent such as an ether (tetrahydrofuran or dioxane for example), an amide (dimethylformamide) or a chlorinated solvent (methylene chloride, 1,2-dichloroethane or chloroform for example) at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture, or after prior binding of the acid to a resin of the TFP type of formula:
  • a condensing agent which is used in peptide chemistry
  • a condensing agent which is used in peptide chemistry
  • a condensing agent which is used in
  • S represents an aminopolystyrene resin
  • an inert solvent such as dimethylformamide
  • 4-dimethylaminopyridine at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • the binding to the resin is generally carried out in dimethylformamide, in the presence of 4-dimethylaminopyridine and 1,3-diisopropylcarbodiimide, at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CO—NH—NR 6 R 7 may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —COOR 5 and R 5 represents an alkyl or phenyl radical optionally substituted with halogens, with a hydrazine H 2 N—NR 6 R 7 for which R 6 and R 7 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as dimethylformamide, at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CO—NHR 9 in which R 9 represents a hydrogen atom and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CO—NR 10 R 11 in which R 10 and R 11 are hydrogen atoms may also be prepared by hydrolysis of a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 and/or R 3 and/or R 4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with cyano.
  • This reaction is carried out by any known method which makes it possible to pass from a nitrile to the corresponding carbamoyl without affecting the rest of the molecule.
  • the procedure is carried out using hydrochloric acid, in acetic acid, at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents an aromatic substituted with —O-alk-NR 12 R 13 may also be prepared by reacting a derivative of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C ⁇ C(SO 2 R 1 )-R′ 2 or C(OR′)CH(SO 2 R 1 )R′ 2 , R′, R 1 , R 2 ′, R 3 ′ and R 4 ′ have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R 2 ′, R 3 ′ or R 4 ′ represents an aromatic substituted with -O-alk-Hal in which alk represents an alkyl radical and Hal represents a halogen atom and, preferably, a chlorine or bromine atom, with an amine HNR 12 R 13 in which R 12 R 13 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as acetonitrile, in the presence of an alkali metal carbonate (potassium carbonate for example), at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • an alkali metal carbonate potassium carbonate for example
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a ketone (methyl ethyl ketone for example), in the presence of a base such as an alkali metal carbonate (potassium carbonate for example), at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • a base such as an alkali metal carbonate (potassium carbonate for example)
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 3 and/or R 4 represents an aromatic substituted with -alk-NR 6 R 7 may also be prepared by reacting a derivative of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C ⁇ C(SO 2 R 1 )R′ 2 or C(OR′)CH(SO 2 R 1 )R′ 2 , R′, R 1 , R 2 ′, R 3 ′ and R 4 ′ have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R 3 ′ or R 4 ′ represents a substituted aromatic -alk-Cl in which alk represents an alkyl radical with an amine HNR 6 R 7 in which R 6 R 7 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane for example), optionally in the presence of a nitrogen base such as dimethylaminopyridine, diisopropylethylamine, at a temperature of between 5 and 25° C.
  • a chlorinated solvent dichloromethane for example
  • a nitrogen base such as dimethylaminopyridine, diisopropylethylamine
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane for example), at a temperature of between 10 and 30° C.
  • an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane for example)
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R represents a chain B, R′ represents a hydrogen atom and R 3 and/or R 4 represents an aromatic substituted with hydroxyalkyl in which the alkyl residue contains one carbon atom may also be prepared by reacting diisobutylaluminum hydride with a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R represents a chain B, R′ represents a hydrogen atom and R 3 and/or R 4 represents an aromatic substituted with one or more —COOR 5 radicals, in which R 5 is an alkyl radical.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in toluene, at a temperature of between ⁇ 30° C. and 0° C.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with an alkyl radical may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with an alk-CHO derivative in which alk represents a straight- or branched-chain alkyl radical containing 1 to 5 carbon atoms.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloroethane or chloroform for example), in the presence of NaBH(OCOCH 3 ) 3 , at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloroethane or chloroform for example)
  • the compounds of formula (1) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with a radical —COOalk may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with a derivative of formula Hal-COOalk in which alk represents an alkyl radical and Hal represents a halogen atom and, preferably, a chlorine atom.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in pyridine, at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with a radical —CO—NHalk or —CS—NHalk may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with a derivative of formula Y ⁇ C ⁇ Nalk in which alk represents a straight- or branched-chain alkyl radical containing 1 to 6 carbon atoms and Y represents a sulfur or oxygen atom.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane for example), at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane for example)
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with a radical —CO-alk-NR 14 R 15 may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with an acid of formula R 15 R 14 N-alk-COOH in which alk represents an alkyl radical and R 14 and R 15 have the same meanings as in formula (I), optionally followed by deprotection of the product for which R 14 is a tert-butoxycarbonyl radical in order to obtain the compounds for which R 14 is a hydrogen atom.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloroethane for example), at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • a chlorinated solvent dichloroethane for example
  • the deprotection is carried out using formic acid at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • the compounds of formula (I) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with a radical —CO-alk in which alk represents a methyl radical may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR 6 R 7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with acetic anhydride.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in the presence of pyridine, at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • groups protecting the hydroxyl function there may be mentioned triethylsilyl and tert-butyldimethylsilyl which may be regenerated using tetrabutylammonium fluoride or alternatively asymmetric acetals (methoxymethyl or tetrahydropyranyl for example) with regeneration using hydrochloric acid.
  • groups protecting carboxyl functions there may be mentioned esters (allyl or benzyl for example), oxazoles and 2-alkyl-1,3-oxazolines.
  • Other protecting groups which can be used are described by GREENE T. W. et al., Protecting Groups in Organic Synthesis, second edition, 1991, John Wiley & Sons.
  • the compounds of formula (I) may be purified by the customary known methods, for example by crystallization, chromatography or extraction.
  • the enantiomers of the compounds of formula (I) may be obtained by resolution of the racemates for example by chromatography on a chiral column according to PIRCKLE W. H. et al., Asymmetric synthesis, Vol. 1, Academic Press (1983) or by formation of salts or by synthesis from chiral precursors.
  • the diastereoisomers may be prepared according to known conventional methods (crystallization, chromatography or from chiral precursors).
  • the compounds of formula (I) may be optionally converted to addition salts with an inorganic or organic acid by the action of such an acid in an organic solvent such as an alcohol, a ketone, an ether or a chlorinated solvent. These salts also form part of the invention.
  • salts may be mentioned: benzenesulfonate, hydrobromide, hydrochloride, citrate, ethanesulfonate, fumarate, gluconate, iodate, isethionate, maleate, methane sulfonate, methylene-bis- ⁇ -oxynaphtoate, nitrate, oxalate, pamoate, phosphate, salicylate, succinate, sulfate, tartrate, theophyllineacetate and p-toluenesulfonate.
  • the compounds of formula (I) exhibit advantageous pharmacological properties. These compounds possess a high affinity for the cannabinoid receptors and particularly those of the CB1 type. They are CBI receptor antagonists and are therefore useful in the treatment and prevention of disorders affecting the central nervous system, the immune system, the cardiovascular or endocrine system, the respiratory system, the gastrointestinal apparatus and reproductive disorders (Hollister, Pharm. Rev.; 38, 1986, 1-20, Reny and Sinha, Prog. Drug Res., 36, 71-114 (1991), Consroe and Sandyk, in Marijuana/Cannabinoids, Neurobiology and Neurophysiology, 459, Murphy L. and Barthe A. Eds, CRC Press, 1992) of bacterial, viral and parasitic infections.
  • these compounds may be used for the treatment or prevention of psychoses including schizophrenia, anxiety disorders, depression, epilepsy, neurodegeneration, cerebellar and spinocerebellar disorders, cognitive disorders, cranial trauma, panic attacks, peripheral neuropathies, glaucomas, migraine, Parkinson's disease, Alzeimer's disease, Huntington's chorea, Raynaud's syndrome, tremor, obsessive-compulsive disorder, senile dementia, thymic disorders, Tourette's syndrome, tardive dyskinesia, bipolar disorders, cancers, movement disorders induced by medicaments, dystonia, endotoxemic shocks, hemorrhagic shocks, hypotension, insomnia, immunological diseases, multiple sclerosis, vomiting, asthma, appetite disorders (bulimia, anorexia), obesity, memory disorders, in weaning from chronic treatments and alcohol or drug abuse (opiods, barbiturates, cannabis, cocaine, amphetamine, phencyclide, hallucin
  • the IC 50 of the compounds of formula (I) is less than or equal to 100 nM.
  • the ED50 of the compounds of formula (I) is less than or equal to 50 mg/kg.
  • the compounds of formula (I) exhibit low toxicity. Their LD 50 is greater than 40 mg/kg by the subcutaneous route in mice.
  • R represents a chain (A) or (B) and R′ represents a hydrogen atom or a —COalk radical
  • R 1 represents a methyl or ethyl radical
  • R 2 represents either an aromatic chosen from phenyl and naphthyl, these aromatics being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more halogens, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyl, —COOR 5 , trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl-sulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, —NR 6 R 7 , —CO—NH—NR 6 R 7 , cyano, —CONHR 9 , alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, nitro, —CO—NR 16 R 17 , —O-alkNR 12 R 13 or alkylthioalkyl or a heteroaromatic chosen from isoquinolyl, pyridyl, quinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolyl and thienyl, these heteroaromatics being unsubstituted or substituted with a halogen, alkyl, al
  • R 3 and R 4 which are identical or different, represent either an aromatic chosen from phenyl or naphthyl, these aromatics being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more halogens, alkyl, alkoxy, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, —CONR 10 R 11 , -alk-NR 6 R 7 , hydroxyalkyl, formyl or —COOR 5 , or a heteroaromatic chosen from thiazolyl or thienyl rings, these heteroaromatics being unsubstituted or substituted with a halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, —CONR 10 R 11 , -alk-NR 6 R 7 , hydroxyalkyl or —COOR 5 .
  • R 5 is alkyl or phenyl which is optionally substituted with one or more halogens
  • R 6 and R 7 which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl, —COOalk, cycloalkyl, alkylcycloalkyl, -alk-O-alk or hydroxyalkyl radical or alternatively R 6 and R 7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk, —CO-alk-NR 14 R 15 , oxo, hydroxyalkyl, alk-O-alk or —CO—NH 2 radicals,
  • R 9 represents a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or an alkyl radical substituted with dialkylamino, phenyl, cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with —COOalk) or a 3-to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing one or more heteroatoms chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl radicals,
  • R 10 and R 11 which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or alternatively R 10 and R 11 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl radical,
  • R 12 and R 13 which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or cycloalkyl radical or alternatively R 12 and R 13 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR 14 R 15 radical or a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing a heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen,
  • R 14 and R 15 which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or —COOalk radical
  • R 16 and R 17 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing
  • alk represents an alkyl or alkylene radical
  • R represents a chain (A) or (B),
  • R′ representing a hydrogen atom or a radical —COalk
  • R 1 represents a methyl or ethyl radical
  • R 2 represents either an aromatic chosen from
  • phenyl substituted with one or more halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyl, —COOR 5 (in which R 5 represents an alkyl or phenyl radical optionally substituted with several halogens) trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl-sulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, —NR 6 R 7 (in which R 6 and R 7 , which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or —COOalk radical or alternatively R 6 and R 7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a heterocycle chosen from pyrrolidinyl, piperidyl, piperazinyl or piperazinyl substituted with one or more alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR 14 R 15 radicals, in which R 14 and R 15 , which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl,
  • R 3 and R 4 which are identical or different, represent either an aromatic chosen from
  • alk represents an alkyl or alkylene radical
  • R 2 is a substituted phenyl radical, the latter is monosubstituted and, in particular, at the 3-position or alternatively disubstituted and, in particular at the 3,5, 2,5 or 2,3-positions.
  • R 3 is a substituted phenyl radical
  • the latter is monosubstituted and, in particular, at the 4-position or disubstituted and, in particular, at the 2,4-positions.
  • R 4 is a substituted phenyl radical
  • the latter is monosubstituted and, in particular, at the 4-position or disubstituted and, in particular, at the 2,4-positions.
  • the residue obtained is chomatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and collecting 80 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 17 to 20 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is crystallized from 10 cm 3 of ethyl ether. 0.14 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 210° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: 6.25 cm 3 of 1.6 N n-butyllithium in solution in hexane are added to a solution of 1.4 cm 3 of diisopropylamine in 10 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran, under an argon atmosphere, cooled to 0° C., and then the mixture is cooled to ⁇ 70° C. A mixture of 1.7 g of benzyl methyl sulfone in 30 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran are then added and the stirring is maintained for 45 minutes at ⁇ 70° C.
  • 1-Benzhydrylazetidin-3-one may be prepared according to the procedure described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al. in J. Heterocycl. Chem., 271 (1994).
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.8 g of methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfone and 3.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.6 g of a solid are obtained after purification on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (98.5/1.5 by volume) as eluent.
  • Methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: 10.5 g of oxone R and then 2.6 g of methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfide and 30 cm 3 of ethanol are added, at room temperature, to a solution of 30 cm 3 of water, 30 cm 3 of acetic acid and 15 cm 3 of 36 N sulfuric acid. The mixture is stirred for 48 hours at room temperature and then taken up in 100 cm 3 of water and 100 cm 3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is washed with a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution, decanted off, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 2.8 g of methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a gum.
  • Methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: 1.7 g of sodium methylthiolate are added, while the temperature is kept below 30° C., to a solution of 3.7 g of 3-methylbenzyl bromide in 25 cm 3 of dimethylformamide. The mixture is stirred for 2 hours at a temperature close to 20° C. and then taken up in 50 cm 3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is washed with 3 times 100 cm 3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 2.6 g of methyl(3-methyl-benzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfone and 5.1 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained melting at 226° C.
  • Methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.5 g of methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfide and 12.3 g of oxone R , 3.5 g of methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5.6 g of 4-methylbenzyl bromide and 2.3 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.7 g of methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • the residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99/1 by volume mixture) and collecting 100 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 6 to 17 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 50 cm 3 of ethyl ether.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.4 g of methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfone and 4.3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained melting at 218° C.
  • Methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: by carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.5 g of methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfide and 16.2 g of oxone R , 3.4 g of methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 but starting with 5.6 g of 2-methylbenzyl bromide and 2.1 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.5 g of methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • the solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 3 cm 3 of dichloromethane and 40 cm 3 of ethyl ether.
  • 1.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 204° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (2-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, the residue obtained is taken up in 50 cm 3 of ethyl acetate, filtered and dried. 2.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (2-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.4 g of (2-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 12 g of oxone R , 4 g of (2-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of an oil which crystallizes.
  • (2-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 but starting with 4 g of 2-chlorobenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.4 g of (2-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.1 g of (3-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 3.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.2 g of (3-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 12 g of oxone R , 3.2 g of (3-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4 g of 3-chlorobenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.2 g of 3-chlorobenzylmethylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • the solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 3 cm 3 and 30 cm 3 of ethyl ether.
  • 0.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 192° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.8 g of (4-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 3.24 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid after crystallization from 80 cm 3 .
  • (4-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.5 g of (4-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 12.3 g of oxone R , 3.5 g of (4-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • the solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 2 cm 3 of dichloromethane and 30 cm 3 of ethyl ether. 0.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 204° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (3,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,5-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5.3 g of (3,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 17 g of oxone R , 5 g of (3,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,5-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of 3,5-dichlorobenzyl chloride and 2 g of sodium methylthiolate, 5.3 g of (3,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4.5 g of (3,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,4-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.3 g of (3,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone R , 4.7 g of (3,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,4-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.8 cm 3 of 3,4-dichlorobenzyl chloride and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.3 g of (3,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • the solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 2 cm 3 of dichloromethane and 30 cm 3 of ethyl ether. 1.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 202° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 1.2 g of (2,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 1.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (2,5-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: 1.9 g of sodium methanesulfinate are added, at room temperature, to a solution of 2.7 g of 2,5-dichlorobenzyl chloride in 30 cm 3 of ethanol. The mixture is heated under reflux for 5 hours, cooled to room temperature and then taken up in 50 cm 3 of water and 50 cm 3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is decanted off, washed with 20 cm of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.2 g of (2,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,4-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4.8 g of (2,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.7 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 9.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,4-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a brown foam.
  • (2,4-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4 g of (2,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone R , 4.8 g of (2,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 111° C.
  • (2,4-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.8 cm 3 of 2,4-dichlorobenzyl chloride and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4 g of (2,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.6 g of (2,3-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 3.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 5.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)] azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (2,3-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 3 g of 2,3-dichlorobenzyl chloride and 2.4 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 3.6 g of (2,3-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfonate are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.6 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone and 3.3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 200° C.
  • (3-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.1 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide and 13 g of oxone R , 2.7 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.6 cm 3 of 3-fluorobenzyl bromide and 1.6 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.1 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.4 g of 2-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone and 4.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (2-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 R starting with 3 g of 2-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide and 13 g of oxone R , 3.6 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (2-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.4 cm 3 of 2-fluorobenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3 g of 2-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.8 g of 4-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone and 3.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (4-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3 g of 4-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide and 13 g of oxone R , 3 g of 4-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 110° C.
  • (4-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.5 cm 3 of 4-fluorobenzyl chloride and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3 g of 4-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.2 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl methyl sulfone and 3.7 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,5-Difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.2 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl methyl sulfide and 16 g of oxone R , 3.3 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,5-Difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl bromide and 2 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.9 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (2,3-difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone and 4.8 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 5.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-difluorophenyl)(methyl-sulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a beige solid.
  • (2,3-Difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 4.1 g of 2,3-difluorobenzyl bromide and 4.1 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 4 g of (2,3-difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (2,5-difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone and 4.8 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 5.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a cream-colored solid.
  • (2,5-Difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 4.1 g of 2,5-difluorobenzyl bromide and 4.1 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 4.8 g of (2,5-difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 95° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 8 g of 3-bromobenzyl methyl sulfone and 7.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 3-Bromobenzyl methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 9 g of 3-bromobenzyl methyl sulfide and 27 g of oxone R , 8.2 g of 3-bromobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 3-Bromobenzyl methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 10 g of 3-bromobenzyl bromide and 3.1 g of sodium methylthiolate, 9 g of 3-bromobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-iodophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.7 g of 3-iodobenzyl methyl sulfone and 3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-iodophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 3-Iodobenzyl methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.6 g of 3-iodobenzyl methyl sulfide and 10.3 g of oxone R , 3.7 g of 3-iodobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 3-Iodobenzyl methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of 3-iodobenzyl bromide and 1.3 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4 g of 3-iodobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.4 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfone and 2.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl(3-fluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.6 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfide and 7.2 g of oxone R , 2.4 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3 g of 3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl bromide and 1 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.3 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • the solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 2 cm 3 of dichloromethane and 30 cm 3 of ethyl ether. 1.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 178° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.4 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfone and 3.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.3 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfide and 10 g of oxone R , 3.4 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.9 g of 3-trifluoromethylbenzyl bromide and 1.4 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.3 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3- ⁇ [3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)-methylene ⁇ azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.1 g of methyl[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl]sulfone and 2.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3- ⁇ [(3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)-methylene ⁇ azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 3 g of 3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl chloride and 2 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 3.1 g of methyl[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl]sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 132° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dibromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 6.2 g of (3,5-dibromobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.5 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 10.7 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[3,5-dibromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • (3,5-Dibromobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5.8 g of (3,5-dibromobenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone R , 6.2 g of (3,5-dibromobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,5-Dibromobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 6.6 g of 3,5-dibromobenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 5.8 g of (3,5-dibromobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-nitrophenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.9 g of methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfone and 4.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-nitrophenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • Methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 but starting with 18.1 g of methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfide and 68 g of oxone R , 13.9 g of methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • Methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 17.2 g of 3-nitrobenzyl chloride and 7.7 g of sodium methylthiolate, 18.2 g of methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • the aqueous phase is extracted with 3 times 40 cm 3 of dichloromethane, the extracts are combined, dried over sodium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue is purified on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (50/50 by volume) as eluent, collecting 20 cm 3 fractions.
  • Fractions 13 to 31 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the solid obtained is crystallized from 15 cm 3 of ethyl ether.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3 g of (3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfone and 3.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam after purification by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99/1 by volume) as eluents.
  • (3-Methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.3 g of (3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfide and 13.4 g of oxone R , 3.4 g of (3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of 3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl bromide and 1.7 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.3 g of (3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.9 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.7 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 6.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 6.7 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfide and 27.6 g of oxone R , 3.9 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Cyanobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 8 g of 3-cyanobenzyl bromide and 3.1 g of sodium methylthiolate, 6.8 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • the residue is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (99.4/0.6 by volume) as eluents and collecting 100 cm 3 fractions.
  • Fractions 13 to 16 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the solid obtained is crystallized from 10 cm 3 of ethyl ether.
  • 0.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pentafluorophenoxy-carbonylphenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 182° C.
  • the solid is washed with 20 cm 3 of a mixture of acetic acid and concentrated hydrochloric acid (50-50 by volume) and then with 3 times 20 cm 3 of water and finally with 20 cm 3 of ethanol.
  • the white solid obtained is under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa) at 45° C. and 2.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine hydrochloride are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.4 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone and 4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.4 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone R , 4 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 71° C.
  • (3-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.1 g of 3-methoxybenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.4 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 3.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.9 cm 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 2.9 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by recrystallization from 100 cm 3 of acetonitrile. 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 181° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.5 g of (4-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone and 4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (4-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.4 g of (4-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone R , 3.5 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 113° C.
  • (4-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.1 g of 4-methoxybenzyl chloride and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.4 g of (4-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 4.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.1 cm 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3.5 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethyl acetate (50/50 by volume) as eluents and collecting 40 cm 3 fractions.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (2-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.5 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a brown foam.
  • (2-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 3.1 g of (2-methoxybenzyl) chloride and 4.1 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 4 g of (2-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.5 g of methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfone and 3.8 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 196° C.
  • Methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.2 g of methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfide and 13.7 g of oxone R , 3.6 g of methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a cream-colored solid.
  • Methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of (2-bromomethyl)naphthalene and 1.8 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.2 g of methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-1-yl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4.1 g of methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfone and 4.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-1-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 R starting with 4.3 g of methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfide and 13.9 g of oxone R , 4.1 g of methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4 g of 1-chloromethylnaphthalene chloride and 1.8 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.5 g of methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pyrrolidinophenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 0.77 g of 3-pyrrolidinobenzyl methyl sulfone and 0.76 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 0.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pyrrolidinophenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 1 g of methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfide and 3.3 g of oxone R , 0.8 g of methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfone is obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 2 g of (3-iodobenzyl)methylsulfide, 1.3 cm 3 of pyrrolidine, 1.1 g of sodium tert-butoxide, 0.28 g of 1,1′-bis(diphenylphosphino)-ferrocenyl palladium chloride, 0.63 g of 1,1′-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene and 60 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran is heated under reflux, under a nitrogen stream, for 3 hours. The reaction medium is cooled to room temperature and filtered on sintered glass.
  • the precipitate is washed with 20 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran and 10 cm 3 of dichloromethane and then the filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue is taken up with 30 cm 3 of ethyl acetate and 30 cm 3 of 3 N hydrochloric acid.
  • the organic phase is extracted; 4 g of silica are added and then the mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.5 kPa).
  • the powder obtained is eluted on sintered glass containing 20 g of silica with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (90/10 by volume).
  • the filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • 1.2 g of methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1,1′-Bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocenyl palladium chloride may be prepared according to Hayashi T. et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 106, 158 (1984).
  • reaction mixture is washed 3 times with 150 cm 3 of distilled water and once with 150 cm 3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution and then dried with magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5.5 cm, height 15 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (1/9 by volume) as eluents and collecting 70 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 15 to 36 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • a white foam is obtained which is crystallized from isopropyl ether in order to obtain 0.85 g of a solid melting at 190° C. Recrystallization from 20 cm 3 of ethanol gives 0.70 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine melting at 205° C.
  • Bis(4-chlorophenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933).
  • 3-[(3,5-Difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride may be obtained in the following manner: 160 cm 3 of a 6.2 N hydrochloric acid solution in dioxane are added to a solution of 37 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol in 160 cm 3 of dioxane. After 16 hours at room temperature, the reaction mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • 3-[(3,5-Difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: a solution of 14.0 cm 3 of vinyl chloroformate in 35 cm 3 of dichloromethane is added at 5° C. to a solution of 60.18 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol in 1000 cm 3 of dichloromethane. After 20 hours at room temperature, the reaction mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared according to the following procedure: a solution of 8.1 cm 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide in 17.6 cm 3 of dichloromethane is added to a solution of 5.0 cm 3 of oxalyl chloride in 73 cm 3 of dichloromethane cooled to ⁇ 78° C. After 0.5 hour at ⁇ 78° C., a solution of 16.0 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol dissolved in 50 cm 3 of dichloromethane is poured in.
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared according to the procedure described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al., J. Heterocycl. Chem., (1994), 271 starting with 35.5 g of [bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]amine hydrochloride and 11.0 cm 3 of epichlorohydrin. 9.0 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ol are isolated.
  • Example 38 On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 0.72 g of 1-[bis(4-methoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.0 cm, height 16.5 cm) at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 40 cm 3 fractions, 0.10 g of a white foam is obtained.
  • Bis(4-methoxyphenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933).
  • Bis(4-methylphenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933).
  • the mixture of diastereoisomers 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 39 starting with 2.52 g (RS)-bromo(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methane and 2.85 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5.6 cm, height 19 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (25/75 by volume) as eluent and
  • (RS)-bromo(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933).
  • Bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933), starting with 1.39 g of bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methanol, 3 cm 3 of 33% hydrobromic acid in acetic acid and 0.6 cm 3 of acetyl bromide. 1.59 g of bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)bromomethane are obtained in the form of a brown oil.
  • Bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933), starting with 2.5 g of bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)methanol, 6 cm 3 of 33% hydrobromic acid in acetic acid and 1.2 cm 3 of acetyl bromide. 2.9 g of bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)bromomethane are obtained in the form of a brown oil.
  • [3,5-Bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl]methylsulfone is prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 10 starting with 1.8 g of 3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl chloride and 1.22 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 1.86 g of [3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl]methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Example 38 On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 0.27 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2.4 cm, height 7.5 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (15/85 by volume) as eluent and collecting 20 cm 3 fractions, 0.10 g of (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)
  • the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 39 starting with 0.56 g of (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methane and 0.50 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.0 cm, height 13 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohex
  • (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933) starting with 4.05 g of (RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methanol, 10 cm 3 of 33% hydrobromic acid in acetic acid and 2.1 cm 3 of acetyl bromide. 4.6 g of (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methane are obtained in the form of a greenish oil.
  • 1- ⁇ (4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS) ⁇ -3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be prepared according to the following method: 13.0 cm 3 of 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene are added dropwise to a solution of 34.45 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 3-acetoxy-1- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS) ⁇ -3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidine in 400 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran under argon at 0° C., and after customary treatment, 16.6 g of 1- ⁇
  • 1- ⁇ (4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS) ⁇ azetidin-3-one may be prepared in the following manner: 46 cm 3 of triethylamine are added at room temperature to a solution of 28.32 g of 1- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS) ⁇ azetidin-3-ol in 200 cm 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, and then a solution of 34 g of sulfur trioxide-pyridine complex in 100 cm 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide are added dropwise.
  • the reaction mixture is poured over ice, extracted with ethyl acetate, washed with 3 times 400 cm 3 of water and then with 400 cm 3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 9.2 cm, height 21 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (20/80 by volume) as eluent and collecting 250 cm 3 fractions.
  • 1- ⁇ (4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS) ⁇ azetidin-3-ol may be prepared according to the procedure described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al., J. Heterocycl. Chem., 271 (1994) starting with 35.0 g of ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl ⁇ amine, 8.3 g of epibromohydrin, 5.1 g of sodium hydrogen carbonate and 400 cm 3 of ethanol. 30.3 g of 1- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS) ⁇ azetidin-3-ol are isolated.
  • ⁇ (4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS) ⁇ amine hydrochloride may be prepared according to the method described by GRISAR M. et al., J. Med. Chem., 885 (1973) starting with 67.2 g of 4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)benzonitrile, 88.2 g of 1-bromo-4-chlorobenzene, 11 g of magnesium and 600 cm 3 of ethyl ether. 42.3 g of ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]-methyl-(RS) ⁇ amine are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • reaction mixture is diluted with dichloromethane, washed twice with 80 cm 3 of water and then 80 cm 3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.1 cm, height 13 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane/acetonitrile/methanol (98/1/1 by volume) mixture as eluent and collecting 15 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 13 to 15 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • (RS)-1- ⁇ (4-carboxyphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 1.0 cm 3 of Jones reagent is added to a solution of 0.50 g of (RS)-1- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl ⁇ -3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 10 cm 3 acetone at 0° C.
  • the reaction mixture is poured into distilled water, the product is extracted with 50 cm 3 of ethyl acetate, the organic phase is washed twice with 50 cm 3 of water and then 50 cm 3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the solid obtained is crystallized from an ethyl acetate-cyclohexane mixture, filtered and dried.
  • Example 52 The operation is carried out as in Example 52, starting with 1 g of (RS)-1- ⁇ (4-carboxyphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, 0.38 g of 1,3-dimethylaminopropyl-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride, 22 mg of hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate, 30 cm 3 of dichloromethane and 0.83 cm 3 of a 2 M ethylamine solution in THF, chromatographing on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.1 cm, height 15 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (45/55 by volume) as eluent and collecting 30 cm 3 fractions.
  • Example 52 The operation is carried out as in Example 52, starting with 1 g of (RS)-1- ⁇ (4-carboxyphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, 0.38 g of 1,3-dimethylaminopropyl-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride, 22 mg of hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate, 40 cm 3 of dichloromethane and 0.24 cm 3 of a 7 N solution of ammonium hydroxide in methanol and chromatographing on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.1 cm, height 15 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (60/40 by volume) as eluent and collecting 35 cm 3 fractions.
  • Bis(4-chlorophenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933).
  • 3-[(3,5-Dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 39 starting with 5.6 g of 3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol and 56 cm 3 of a 6.2 N solution of hydrochloric dioxane in 56 cm 3 of dioxane, 5.1 g of 3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-dimethylaminophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 0.4 g of (3-dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfone, 0.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one and 1.2 cm 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 0.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-dimethylaminophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a solid melting at 185° C.
  • (3-Dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 1.4 g of (3-dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfide and 5.1 g of oxone R , 1.1 g of (3-dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 195° C.
  • (3-Dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 37 starting with 4 g of (3-iodobenzyl)methylsulfide, 1.4 g of dimethylamine in solution in 5 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran, 2.9 g of sodium tert-butoxide, 0.56 g of 1,1-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocenylpalladium chloride and 1.3 g of 1,1′-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene in 35 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran, 0.9 g of (3-dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfide is obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 1.1 g of methyl(3-methylsulfanylbenzyl)sulfone, 1.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Methyl(3-methylsulfanylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 5 g of (3-iodobenzyl)methylsulfone and 1 g of tetrakistriphenylphosphinepalladium in 250 cm 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide is heated at a temperature close to 100° C., under a nitrogen stream, for 1 hour. 2.5 g of sodium methylthiolate are added and then the heating at 100° C. is maintained for 18 hours. The reaction medium is cooled to room temperature and taken up in 700 cm 3 of ethyl acetate and 500 cm 3 of water.
  • the organic phase is decanted off, washed with 10 times 500 cm 3 of water, 500 cm 3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, filtered on sintered glass and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (70/30 and then 60/40 and then 50/50 by volume) as eluent and collecting 30 cm 3 fractions.
  • Fractions 26 to 30 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • 1.2 g of methyl(3-methylsulfanyl-benzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • the organic phase is decanted off, extracted, dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (95/5 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm 3fractions. Fractions 4 to 6 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3- ⁇ [3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)phenyl]-(methylsulfonyl)methylene ⁇ azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 1.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3- ⁇ [3-(tert-butyldimethylsiloxymethyl)phenyl](methyl-sulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.3 cm 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.4 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 60 cm 3 fractions.
  • [0526] [(3-(Tert-butyldimethylsilyloxy-methyl)benzyl]methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 13.4 g of (3-hydroxymethylbenzyl)methylsulfone, 11 g of imidazole and 12 g of tert-butyldimethylsilane chloride is stirred for 18 hours at a temperature close to 20° C. The solution is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • (3-Hydroxymethylbenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 26 g of 3-(methylsulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid and 4.6 g of lithium aluminium hydride in 600 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran is stirred for 18 hours at a temperature close to 20° C. The solution is cooled to 0° C. and then 15 cm 3 of ethyl acetate, 5 cm 3 of water, 5 cm 3 of a 15% aqueous solution of sodium hydroxide and finally 30 cm 3 of water are added successively. The mixture is filtered on celite, the filtrate taken up in 600 cm 3 of ethyl acetate.
  • 3-(Methylsulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 23.3 g of 3-chloromethylbenzoic acid and 23.3 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 26 g of 3-(methylsulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 210° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromomethylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 0.23 cm 3 of phosphorus tribromide and then a drop of pyridine are added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to a mixture of 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-hydroxymethylphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 10 cm 3 of dichloromethane. The stirring is maintained for 18 hours at the same temperature. The reaction medium is taken up in 20 cm 3 of water and 10 cm 3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(quinol-8-yl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 5.5 g of methyl(quinol-8-ylmethyl)sulfone, 5.9 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one and 18.8 cm 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 6.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(quinol-8-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a beige solid.
  • Methyl(quinol-8-ylmethyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 4.5 g of 8-chloromethylquinoline and 4.4 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 5.7 g of methyl(quinol-8-ylmethyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a beige solid.
  • 8-Chloromethyl quinoline may be prepared in the following manner: 6.7 g of N-chlorosuccinimide and then 250 mg of benzoyl peroxide are added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to a mixture of 7.1 g of 8-methylquinoline in 250 cm 3 of carbon tetrachloride. The reaction medium is heated at the reflux temperature of the solvent for 36 hours and then cooled to 20° C. The mixture is filtered on sintered glass and the filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5.5 cm, height 32 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 40 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 21 to 40 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 4.5 g of 8-chloromethyl-quinoline are obtained in the form of a brown oil which is used in the crude state in subsequent syntheses.
  • the solid obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 25 cm, height 40 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99.5/0.5 by volume) as eluent and collecting 30 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 35 to 46 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 15 cm 3 of ethyl ether.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3- ⁇ [3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS) ⁇ azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 1.6 g of [3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)benzyl]methylsulfone, 1.3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one and 3.8 cm 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 0.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3- ⁇ [3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS) ⁇ azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • [3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)benzyl]methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: 2.5 g of di-tert-butyl dicarbonate in 40 cm 3 of dioxane are added to a solution, cooled to 0° C. of methyl(3-methylaminobenzyl)sulfone in 30 cm 3 of dioxane. The stirring is maintained for 18 hours at room temperature. The reaction medium is taken up in 75 cm 3 of dichloromethane; the organic phase is washed with 75 cm 3 of water and then with 75 cm 3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution.
  • the mixture is filtered on sintered glass, the precipitate is washed with 3 times 50 cm 3 of diisopropyl ether and then dried.
  • the filtrate is concentrated to half its volume (2.7 kPa), the precipitate obtained is filtered on sintered glass and washed with 3 times 30 cm 3 of diisopropyl ether and then dried.
  • the two precipitates are combined and dissolved in 375 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran.
  • the solution is cooled to 0° C.; 100 cm 3 of a 2 M solution of borane dimethyl sulfide in tetrahydrofuran added and then heated under reflux for 3 hours.
  • the mixture is cooled to 5° C. and then 60 cm 3 of methanol are added over 20 minutes.
  • the stirring is maintained for 1 hour at room temperature.
  • a stream of hydrogen chloride is bubbled in the solution for 5 minutes.
  • the reaction medium is then heated under reflux for 1 hour, cooled to room temperature and taken up in 300 cm 3 of water.
  • the solution is alkalinized with 3N sodium hydroxide and then with a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution.
  • the organic phase is extracted with twice 250 cm 3 of ethyl acetate, washed with 300 cm 3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution and twice 300 cm 3 . It is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the oil obtained is taken up in 100 cm 3 of 4 N hydrochloric acid and then with 100 cm 3 of ethyl acetate.
  • the aqueous phase is alkalinized with 120 cm 3 of 3 N sodium hydroxide, and then with an aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution.
  • the organic phase is extracted with twice 75 cm 3 of ethyl acetate, dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 9 g of methyl(3-methylaminobenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a pink solid.
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3- ⁇ (methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene ⁇ azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 29 starting with 2.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine hydrochloride, 0.9 g of pentafluorophenol, 0.9 g of 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride in 25 cm 3 of dimethylformamide, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (99/1
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 2 cm 3 of Jones reagent are added to a mixture of 0.5 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-hydroxymethylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine in 9 cm 3 of acetone, cooled to 5° C. This stirring is maintained for 2 hours at this temperature and then 50 cm 3 of a mixture of water and ice and 50 cm 3 of ethyl acetate are added.
  • the organic phase is decanted off, washed with 50 cm 3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol as eluent and collecting 60 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 14 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the solid obtained is crystallized from 10 cm 3 of ethyl ether.
  • Fractions 12 to 17 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue obtained is again purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 20 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 30 cm 3 fractions.
  • Fractions 15 to 28 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.25 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylphenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 70° C.
  • Methyl(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 5 g of 3-trifluoromethylsulfanylbenzyl chloride and 3.2 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 5.2 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 125° C.
  • Example 38 On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 0.72 g of 1-[bis(4-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.18 cm 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.66 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.42 g of 1-[bis(4-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2.5 cm, height 15 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (15/85 by volume) as eluent and collecting 25 cm 3 fractions, in the form
  • Bis(4-fluorophenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933) starting with 4 g of 4,4′-difluorobenzydrol, 2.70 cm 3 of acetal bromide and 14 cm 3 of a 33% hydrobromic acid solution in acetic acid.
  • Example 38 On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 1.22 g of 1-[bis(2-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.29 cm 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.1 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.177 g of 1-[bis(2-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 23 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (15/85 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm 3 fractions, in the form of
  • Bis(2-fluorophenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933), starting with 1.80 g of 2,2′-difluorobenzydrol, 1.22 cm 3 of acetyl bromide and 6.5 cm 3 of a 33% solution of hydrobromic acid in acetic acid.
  • 2,2′-difluorobenzydrol may be prepared according to the following method: 32 cm 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane are poured dropwise into a solution, cooled to ⁇ 70° C. under argon, of 8.8 g of 2-bromofluorobenzene in 100 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran. After stirring for 10 minutes at ⁇ 70° C., 2.1 cm 3 of ethyl formate are added slowly and then the mixture is stirred at ⁇ 70° C. for 30 minutes. The reaction medium is then brought to 0° C.
  • Example 38 On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 1.15 g of 1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.264 cm 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride, and 0.98 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.55 g of 1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 2.8 cm, height 25 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (15/85 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm 3 fractions, in
  • 1-[Bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 1 starting with 1.2 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 1.5 g of 1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one, 1.95 g of 1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained, after purification on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 3.2 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexan
  • [0568] is(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]amine may be prepared in the following manner: a solution of 5.17 g of 3,3′-difluorobenzophenone oxime in 30 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran is poured, under an argon atmosphere over 30 minutes, into a suspension of 1.27 g of lithium aluminum hydride in 80 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran. After stirring for 5 hours under reflux, 1.3 cm 3 of water, 1.3 cm 3 of 4 N sodium hydroxide, 2.6 cm 3 of water and then 50 cm 3 of ethyl acetate are added successively. After drying over magnesium sulfate and concentrating to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa), 4.9 g of [bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]amine are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • 3-3′-Difluorobenzophenone oxime may be prepared according to the following procedure: a solution of 1.6 g of hydroxylamine hydrochloride in 8 cm 3 of water is poured dropwise into a solution of 5.0 g of 3,3′-difluorobenzophenone in 10 cm 3 of ethanol, and then 1.2 g of sodium hydroxide pellets are added in small fractions. The reaction mixture, heated under reflux for 10 minutes, is cooled to 20° C. and then acidified with 7.5 cm 3 of 4 N hydrochloric acid. Once triturated, the oily precipitate obtained becomes a white solid which is filtered, washed with water and then dried at 35° C. under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 5.17g of 3,3′-difluorobenzophenone oxime are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thiazol-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 39 starting with 4.47 g of (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)-methane and 4.31 g of 3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 5.6 cm, height 40 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (25/75 by volume) up to fraction 35 and then with pure ethy
  • (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933), starting with 3.5 g of (RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(2-thiazolyl)methanol, 3.81 g of acetyl bromide and 12.0 cm 3 of a 33% solution of hydrobromic acid in acetic acid.
  • (RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methanol may be prepared according to the procedure described by G. EVAN BOSWELL et al., J. Heterocyclic Chem., 32, 1801 (1995), starting with 4.22 g of 4-chlorobenzaldehyde and 4.92 g of 2-bromothiazole.
  • the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 1 starting with 1.60 cm 3 of 1.6 N n-butyllithium in solution in hexane, 0.83 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 1.06 g of 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-one, 0.55 g of the mixture of diastereoisomers 1-[4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl
  • [0578] [(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-amine may be prepared in the following manner: a solution of 10.92 g of 2-thiophenecarbonitrile in 80 cm 3 of ethyl ether is poured slowly into a suspension, cooled to 10° C., of 4-chlorophenylmagnesium bromide (prepared from 19.15 g of 4-bromochlorobenzene and 2.43 g of magnesium) in 120 cm 3 of anhydrous ethyl ether. After refluxing for one hour, the mixture is cooled to 10° C., supplemented slowly with 40 cm 3 of methanol and then filtered on supercel.
  • 4-chlorophenylmagnesium bromide prepared from 19.15 g of 4-bromochlorobenzene and 2.43 g of magnesium
  • (+)-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 12.4 g of (+)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol, 220 cm 3 of dichloromethane, 7.1 cm 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, 4.4 cm 3 of oxalyl chloride and 21.5 cm 3 of triethylamine. 9.2 g of (+)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of a pale yellow oil crystallizing at 20° C.
  • (+)-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ol may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 16.1 g of (+)-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine, 130 cm 3 of ethanol, 5.9 cm 3 of epibromohydrin and 6.05 g of sodium bicarbonate. 11.5 g of (+)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ol are obtained, after purification by chromatography, in the form of a cream-colored oil.
  • (+)-4-[(Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine may be prepared in the following manner: 73 g of D-( ⁇ )-tartaric acid are added to a solution of 109 g of [(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]amine in 500 cm 3 of methanol. The mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The foam obtained is taken up in 2.05 liters of an ethanol-water 90/10 by volume mixture. After stirring slowly for 20 hours at 20° C., the crystalline suspension obtained is filtered, the crystals washed with a minimum amount of the same mixture of solvents, and then dried.
  • ( ⁇ )-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 11.4 g of ( ⁇ )-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol, 200 cm 3 of dichloromethane, 4.0 cm 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, 4.0 cm 3 of oxalyl chloride and 19.5 cm 3 of triethylamine. 8.3 g of ( ⁇ )-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of a pale yellow oil crystallizing at 20° C.
  • ( ⁇ )-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 15.4 g of ( ⁇ )-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine, 120 cm 3 of ethanol, 5.8 cm 3 of epibromohydrin and 5.8 g of sodium bicarbonate. 10.7 g of ( ⁇ )-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ol are obtained, after purification by chromatography, in the form of a cream-colored oil.
  • ( ⁇ )-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine may be prepared in the following manner: 29 g of L-(+)-tartaric acid are added to a solution of 43 g of [(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]amine in 200 cm 3 of methanol. The mixture obtained crystallizes in 2 hours at room temperature. The crystals are filtered, washed with twice 10 cm 3 of methanol. Recrystallization is carried out with 500 cm 3 of an ethanol-water 80/20 by volume mixture, the crystals are filtered, washed with twice 30 cm 3 of the same mixture of solvents and then dried under vacuum at 45° C.
  • a final recrystallization is carried out with 350 cm 3 of an ethanol-water 78/22 by volume mixture, allowing the mixture to be stirred for 20 hours at 20° C.
  • the crystals obtained are drained, dried under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • 26 g of acid L-(+)-tartrate of ( ⁇ )-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine are obtained.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(ethylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained by carrying out the operation according to the procedure described in Example 1 starting with 2.4 g of benzylethylsulfone, 2.2 cm 3 of diisopropylamine, 10 cm 3 of 1.6 N n-butyllithium in solution in hexane, 65 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran and 3.1 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one.
  • Benzylethylsulfone may be prepared by carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 6.3 g of benzylethylsulfide, 50 cm 3 of acetic acid, 50 cm 3 of water, 25 cm 3 of 36 N sulfuric acid and 24.8 g of oxone R . 3.2 g of benzylethylsulfone are obtained, by recrystallization from 20 cm of ethyl ether, in the form of a solid melting at 86° C.
  • Benzylethylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: 1.2 g of sodium hydride are added in small portions to a solution of 5 g of benzylmercaptan in 50 cm 3 of dimethylformamide under argon, and then 3.36 cm 3 of ethyl iodide are poured in, while the temperature is maintained below 45° C. The mixture is stirred for 2 hours and then taken up in 200 cm 3 of ethyl ether. The organic phase is washed with 200 cm 3 of water and then with 3 times 100 cm 3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 6.3 g of benzylethylsulfide are obtained in the form of a pale yellow liquid.
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3- ⁇ (methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 0.94 g of N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-N′-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride and 0.89 g of pentafluorophenol are added to a solution of 2.9 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine in 25 cm 3 of dimethylformamide.
  • the mixture is stirred for 20 hours at room temperature and then taken up in 50 cm 3 of ethyl acetate.
  • the organic phase is washed with 100 cm 3 of water, 200 cm 3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution and then with twice 50 cm 3 of distilled water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa).
  • the residue is chromatographed on a silica column (particle size 0.04-0.006 mm, diameter 2 cm), eluting with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (99/1 by volume).
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: a 36% solution of hydrochloric acid at a temperature of 50° C. is added to a solution of 3.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 5 cm 3 of acetic acid. The heating is continued for 48 hours and then the mixture is evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). The residue is taken up in 30 cm 3 of ethanol and again evaporated to dryness.
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine may be prepared according to the procedure of Example 4, starting with 11 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 150 cm 3 of dichloromethane, 2.54 cm 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 10.7 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, at room temperature for 3 hours.
  • (3-Cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: starting with a solution of 20.2 g of 3-chloromethylbenzonitrile in 200 cm 3 of ethanol, 17.4 g of 85% sodium methanesulfinate are added. The mixture is stirred for 20 hours under reflux and then taken up in 500 cm 3 of ethyl acetate and 500 cm 3 of water. The insoluble matter is filtered off, the organic phase in the filtrate is dried over magnesium sulfate and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). The solid obtained is triturated with 100 cm 3 of ethyl ether. After filtration and drying of the solid, 21 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of white crystals melting at 165° C.
  • 3-Chloromethylbenzonitrile may be prepared in the following manner: 32 g of 3-chloromethylbenzoamide in 200 cm 3 of phosphorus oxychloride are heated at 95° C. for 3 hours, and then 1 liter of ice is loaded, the mixture stirred for 1 hour and extracted with 500 cm 3 of dichloromethane. The organic phase is washed with 200 cm 3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). 20.2 g of 3-chloromethylbenzonitrile are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Example 79 On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 79 starting with 0.5 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-0.3- ⁇ (methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene ⁇ azetidine, 0.06 cm 3 , 1,1-dimethylhydrazine and 5 cm 3 of dimethylformamide, 0.125 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3- ⁇ (3-(2,2-dimethylcarbohydrazido)phenyl] (methylsulfonyl)methylene ⁇ azetidine is obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 134° C.
  • 1-[Bis-thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 73, starting with 4 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol, 2.6 cm 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, 7.7 cm 3 of triethylamine, 7.7 cm 3 of oxalyl chloride, and 100 cm 3 of dichloromethane. The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) with, as eluent, a mixture of cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (1/1 by volume). The fractions obtained are evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). 3.2 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of cream-colored crystals melting at 70° C.
  • 1-[Bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 73, starting with 6 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine, 2.5 cm 3 of epibromohydrin, 2.6 g of sodium bicarbonate and 50 cm 3 of ethanol. 4 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of beige crystals melting at 115° C.
  • 1-[Bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine may be prepared in the following manner: a solution of 5 cm 3 of thien-2-ylcarbonitrile in 50 cm 3 of diethyl ether is poured dropwise into a suspension, cooled under argon to 10° C., of thien-2-ylmagnesium bromide (prepared from 1.29 g of magnesium and 3.22 cm 3 2-bromothiophene in 75 cm 3 of diethyl ether). After refluxing for 1 hour and 30 minutes, the reaction medium is cooled to 5° C. and then 20 cm of methanol are poured in dropwise, the suspension filtered and the solid washed with methanol. The filtrate obtained a brown solution.
  • 1-(Bis-p-tolylmethyl)-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared according to the procedure described in Example 39, starting with 0.59 g of bromo(bis-p-tolyl)methane, 20 cm 3 of acetonitrile, 0.3 g of potassium carbonate and 0.6 g of 3-[(methylsulfonyl)-(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride.
  • Bromo(di-p-tolyl)methane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933).
  • the white foam obtained is purified on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3.2 cm, height 17 cm) with, as eluent, a cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (60/40 by volume) mixture.
  • ( ⁇ )-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)methylsulfonylmethylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 3.32 cm 3 of a 5 N solution of hydrochloric acid are poured into a solution of 0.83 g of (+)-1- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl ⁇ -3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 5 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran and then the mixture is kept stirring for 20 hours.
  • (+)-1- ⁇ (4-Chlorophenyl) [4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl ⁇ -3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be obtained in the following manner: 0.93 g of 1,8-Diazabicyclo[5-4-O]undec-7-ene is poured dropwise into a solution of 2.42 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 3-acetoxy-1- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(R*) ⁇ -3-[(3,5-difluoro-phenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]azetidine and 3-acetoxy-1- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl) [4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)
  • the reaction medium is diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with water and with a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution.
  • the organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure.
  • the crude product is purified on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.8 cm, height 17.5 cm) with, as eluent, a cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (80/20 by volume) mixture.
  • reaction medium is thrown over water, the mixture is extracted with ethyl acetate, the organic phase washed with water and with a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa).
  • (+)-1- ⁇ (4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl ⁇ azetidin-3-one may be prepared in the following manner: 2.24 cm 3 of triethylamine are poured into a solution of 1.38g of (+)-1- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl ⁇ azetidin-3-ol in 20 cm 3 of anhydrous dimethyl sulfoxide under argon, followed dropwise by 1.65 g of a solution of sulfur trioxide pyridine complex in 20 cm 3 of anhydrous dimethyl sulfoxide.
  • (+)-1- ⁇ (4-Chlorophenyl) [4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl ⁇ azetidin-3-ol may be described according to the procedure described in Example 73, starting with 4.43 g of (+)- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl ⁇ amine, 40 cm 3 of absolute ethanol, 1.25 cm 3 of epibromohydrin and 1.28 g of sodium bicarbonate.
  • Chiral (+)- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl) [4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl ⁇ amine may be obtained in the following manner: 3.95 cm 3 of ethylene glycol are poured into a suspension of 18.16 g of chiral (R*)-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]amine hydrochloride, in 1000 cm 3 of toluene, and 0.82 g of para-toluenesulfonic acid monohydrate is added.
  • Chiral (R*)-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]amine hydrochloride may be prepared in the following manner: 330 cm of methanol are poured into a solution of 51.4 g of the diastereoisomer N- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethoxymethyl)phenyl]methyl-(R*) ⁇ -(R)-2-phenylglycinol in 660 cm 3 of anhydrous dichloromethane, the mixture cooled with an ice bath, 60.96 g of lead tetraacetate added, the mixture stirred for 5 minutes and then 1 liter of a phosphate buffer solution pH 7 poured in.
  • N- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethoxymethyl)phenyl]methyl-(R*) ⁇ -(R)-2-phenylglycinol may be prepared in the following manner: 286 cm 3 of 1.6 M n-butyllithium in hexane are poured dropwise into a solution, cooled to ⁇ 70° C., under argon, of 87.7 g of 4-bromochlorobenzene and the mixture is stirred for 15 minutes at ⁇ 70° C.
  • (R)-N-[4-(diethoxymethyl)benzylidene]-2-phenylglycinol may be prepared in the following manner: 35.9 cm 3 of 4-(diethoxymethyl)benzaldehyde are poured into a white suspension of 24.7 g of (R)-( ⁇ )-2-phenylglycinol in 500 cm 3 of toluene. The cloudy yellow solution is heated under reflux for 6 hours 30 minutes, and is then stirred at room temperature for 20 hours.
  • the crude product obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm and weight of silica 250 g), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with an ethyl acetate/cyclohexane (30/70 by volume) mixture and collecting 100 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 18 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa).
  • the crude product is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, weight of silica 250 g), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99/1 by volume) and collecting 500 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 10 to 16 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 72, starting with 1.01 g of (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)thiazol-2-ylmethane and 0.55 g of (RS)-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 4.4 cm, height 38 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar and eluting with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (30/70
  • reaction mixture is washed with water and then the organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under vacuum (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.2 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.1 bar, eluting with dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (97.5/2.5 by volume) and collecting 3 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 40 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.2 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.1 bar, eluting with a cyclohexane and ethyl acetate mixture (50/50 by volume) and collecting 30 cm 3 fractions. Fractions 4 to 12 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • 1- ⁇ (R*)-[(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)-phenyl]methyl ⁇ azetidin-3-one, form A isomer may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 40, starting with 0.55 cm 3 of oxalyl chloride, 25 cm 3 of dichloromethane, 0.90 cm 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, 1.75 g of 1- ⁇ (4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl ⁇ azetidin-3-ol, and 2.70 cm 3 of triethylamine.
  • Methyl (+)-4-[(R*)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 2.51 g of D-( ⁇ )-tartaric acid are added to a solution of 9.2 g of methyl (4-[(RS)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate in 10 cm 3 of methanol. The solution is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The cream-colored foam obtained is dissolved in 50 cm 3 of ethanol containing 5% water and the resulting solution is allowed to crystallize for 20 hours at 20° C.
  • the crystals are filtered, washed with ethanol containing 5% water, drained and then dried under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 3.4 g of white crystals are obtained which are called “A crystals” [and which are stored for the subsequent preparation of the second enantiomer, methyl ( ⁇ )-4-[(R*)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate].
  • the mother liquors are concentrated to dryness and a white foam (8.1 g) is obtained which is dissolved in 100 cm 3 of ethyl acetate.
  • the solution obtained is supplemented with 50 cm 3 of 1 N sodium hydroxide, stirred and separated after settling out.
  • the organic phase is washed with 50 cm 3 of water and then dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • a yellow solid is obtained which is dissolved in 100 cm 3 of methanol.
  • the solution obtained is supplemented with 1.85 g of L-(+)-tartaric acid and the resulting solution is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • a cream-colored foam is obtained which, once dissolved in 27 cm 3 of ethanol containing 4% water, is allowed to crystallize for 20 hours at 20° C.
  • the crystals are filtered, washed with ethanol containing 4% water, drained and then dried under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • Methyl 4-[(RS)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 3.9 cm 3 of hydrazine hydrate are added to a suspension of 16.3 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-phthalimido-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate in 200 cm 3 of methanol. After stirring for 5 hours at the reflux temperature and then for 20 hours at 20° C., the reaction mixture is filtered and the filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • Methyl 4-[(RS)-phthalimido-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 12.6 g of potassium phthalimide are added to a solution of 11.6 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-bromo-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate in 70 cm 3 of dimethylformamide. After stirring for 3 hours at the reflux temperature, the reaction mixture is cooled to 20° C. and then supplemented with 300 cm 3 of ethyl acetate and 300 cm 3 of water.
  • Methyl 4-[(RS)-bromo-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 10.18 g of N,N′-carbonyldiimidazole and 54.3 cm 3 of allyl bromide are added to a solution of 17.4 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(hydroxy)methyl]benzoate in 200 cm 3 of acetonitrile. After stirring for 30 minutes at 20° C., the reaction mixture is heated under reflux for 2 hours, stirred for 20 hours at 20° C. and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • Methyl 4-[(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(hydroxy)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 1.21 g of sodium borohydride are slowly added in small fractions to a suspension of 2.75 g of methyl 4-(4-chlorobenzoyl)benzoate in 200 cm 3 of methanol at 20° C. (heating of the medium up to 50° C. occurs). After stirring for 20 hours at 20° C., the reaction mixture is concentrated to a reduced volume and then supplemented with 150 cm 3 of dichloromethane and, while stirring, with 100 cm 3 of 0.5 N hydrochloric acid.
  • Methyl 4-(4-chlorobenzoyl)benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 27.4 cm 3 of tri-n-butylphosphine are added, under argon, to a solution, cooled to ⁇ 22° C., of 19.3 g of terephthalic acid chloride monomethyl ester in 200 cm 3 of tetrahydrofuran.
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then eluting with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (95/5) by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture.
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm 3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm 3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 10 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm 3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm 3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 5 to 10 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm 3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 4 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).
  • the crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm 3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm 3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 10 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa).

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Neurology (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • Neurosurgery (AREA)
  • Psychiatry (AREA)
  • Pain & Pain Management (AREA)
  • Communicable Diseases (AREA)
  • Immunology (AREA)
  • Oncology (AREA)
  • Cardiology (AREA)
  • Heart & Thoracic Surgery (AREA)
  • Pulmonology (AREA)
  • Hospice & Palliative Care (AREA)
  • Ophthalmology & Optometry (AREA)
  • Diabetes (AREA)
  • Psychology (AREA)
  • Child & Adolescent Psychology (AREA)
  • Addiction (AREA)
  • Hematology (AREA)
  • Virology (AREA)
  • Obesity (AREA)
  • Endocrinology (AREA)
  • Tropical Medicine & Parasitology (AREA)
  • Otolaryngology (AREA)
  • Orthopedic Medicine & Surgery (AREA)
  • Physical Education & Sports Medicine (AREA)

Abstract

Disclosed are azetidine derivatives of formula:
Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00001
their optical isomers, their salts, their preparation and medicaments containing them.

Description

    CROSS REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • This application is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 10/320,344, filed Dec. 16, 2002, which is a continuation of U.S. application Ser. No. 09/803,723, filed Mar. 9, 2001, now U.S. Pat. No. 6,518,264 which is a continuation of International Application No. PCT/FR99/02147, filed Sep. 9, 1999, which, in turn, claims the benefit of U.S. Provisional Application No, 60/119,929, filed on Feb. 12, 1999, and of French Patent Application FR98/11342, filed on Sep. 11, 1998.[0001]
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • The present invention relates to azetidine derivatives of formula: [0002]
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00002
  • their optical isomers, their salts, their preparation and medicaments containing them, as well as to methods of using these derivatives to treat a variety of medical conditions and disorders.[0003]
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION
  • In formula (I), [0004]
  • R represents a chain [0005]
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00003
  • R[0006] 1 represents a methyl or ethyl radical,
  • R[0007] 2 represents either an aromatic chosen from phenyl, naphthyl or indenyl, these aromatics being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more halogens, alkyl, alkoxy, —CO-alk, hydroxyl, —COOR5, formyl, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethylsulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, nitro, —NR6R7, —CO—NH—NR6R7, —N(alk)COOR8, cyano, —CONHR9, —CO—NR16R17, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, —O-alk-NR12R13 or alkylthioalkyl or a heteroaromatic chosen from the benzofuryl, benzothiazolyl, benzothienyl, benzoxazolyl, chromanyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuryl, 2,3-dihydrobenzothienyl, indolinyl, isochromanyl, isoquinolyl, pyridyl, quinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolyl, thiazolyl, or thienyl rings, it being possible for these heteroaromatics to be nonsubstituted or substituted with a halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, —COOR5, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethylsulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, nitro, —NR6R7, —CO—NH—NR6R7, cyano, —CONHR9, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl or alkylthioalkyl,
  • R[0008] 3 and R4, which are identical or different, represent either an aromatic chosen from phenyl, naphthyl or indenyl, these aromatics being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more halogens, alkyl, alkoxy, formyl, hydroxyl, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, —CO-alk, cyano, —COOR5, —CONR10R11, —CO—NH—NR6R7, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-NR6R7 or alkylthioalkyl; or a heteroaromatic chosen from benzofuryl, benzothiazolyl, benzothienyl, benzoxazolyl, chromanyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuryl, 2,3-dihydrobenzothienyl, furyl, isochromanyl, isoquinolyl, pyrrolyl, quinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolyl, thiazolyl or thienyl rings, it being possible for these heteroaromatics to be nonsubstituted or substituted with a halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyl, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, cyano, —COOR5, —CO—NH—NR6R7, —CONR10R11, -alk-NR6R7, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl or alkylthioalkyl;
  • R[0009] 5 is an alkyl or phenyl radical which is optionally substituted with one or more halogen atoms,
  • R[0010] 6 and R7, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl, —COOalk, cycloalkyl, alkylcycloalkyl, -alk-O-alk or hydroxyalkyl radical or alternatively R6 and R7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk, —CO-alk-NR14R15, oxo, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-O-alk or —CO—NH2 radicals,
  • R[0011] 8 represents an alkyl radical,
  • R[0012] 9 represents a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or an alkyl radical substituted with a dialkylamino, phenyl, cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with —COOalk) or a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing one or more heteroatoms chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl radicals,
  • R[0013] 10 and R11, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or alternatively R10 and R11 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl radical,
  • R[0014] 12 and R13, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or cycloalkyl radical or alternatively R12 and R13 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 radical or a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing a heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen,
  • R[0015] 14 and R15, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or —COOalk radical,
  • R[0016] 16 and R17 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen,
  • R′ represents a hydrogen atom or a —CO-alk radical, alk represents an alkyl or alkylene radical. [0017]
  • In the preceding definitions and in those which follow, unless otherwise stated, the alkyl and alkylene radicals and portions and the alkoxy radicals and portions are in the form of a straight or branched chain and contain 1 to 6 carbon atoms. [0018]
  • Among the alkyl radicals, there may be mentioned methyl, ethyl, n-propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, sec-butyl, iso-butyl, tert-butyl, pentyl and hexyl radicals. Among the alkoxy radicals, there may be mentioned methoxy, ethoxy, n-propoxy, iso-propoxy, n-butoxy, iso-butoxy, sec-butoxy, tert-butoxy and pentyloxy radicals. [0019]
  • The term halogen comprises chlorine, fluorine, bromine and iodine. [0020]
  • When R[0021] 2 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent independently a substituted phenyl, the latter is preferably mono-, di- or trisubstituted.
  • When R[0022] 6 and R7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, the latter is preferably an azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidyl, morpholinyl, imidazolyl, thiomorpholinyl or furyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with an alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-O-alk, —CONH2, —COalk, —COOalk, oxo, —CSNHalk, —CONHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 radical and, in particular, with a methyl, ethyl, propyl, isobutyl, acetyl, N,N-dimethylaminomethylcarbonyl, methyloxycarbonyl, methylcarbamoyl, methylthiocarbamoyl, N-methylaminomethylcarbonyl, N-methyl-N-tertbutoxycarbonylaminomethylcarbonyl, oxo, —CSNHCH3 or —CONHCH3 radical.
  • When R[0023] 10 and R11, together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, the latter is preferably an azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidyl, morpholinyl or thiomorpholinyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with an alkyl.
  • When R[0024] 12 and R13 form together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, the latter is preferably an azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidyl, morpholinyl or thiomorpholinyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with an alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 radical or a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing a heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, and, in particular, with a thiomorpholinyl radical.
  • When R[0025] 16 and R17 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, the latter is preferably a piperidyl ring.
  • When R[0026] 9 represents an alkyl radical substituted with a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing one or more heteroatoms chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, the latter is preferably a pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuryl, morpholinyl or pyrrolyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl radicals.
  • The compounds of formula (I) may be provided in the form of enantiomers and diastereoisomers. These optical isomers and mixtures thereof form part of the invention. [0027]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R represents a chain of formula (A) may be prepared by dehydration of a corresponding compound of formula (Ia) [0028]
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00004
  • in which R[0029] 1, R2, R3 and R4 have the same meanings as in formula (I) and R″ represents a hydroxyl, methanesulfonyloxy or acetyloxy radical.
  • This dehydration is carried out by any method known to persons skilled in the art which makes it possible to dehydrate an alcohol or one of its derivatives in order to obtain the corresponding alkene. Preferably, derivatives are used for which R″ is a methanesulfonyloxy or acetyloxy radical obtained from the corresponding derivative for which R″ is a hydroxyl radical by the action of methanesulfonyl chloride or acetyl chloride, in an inert solvent such as pyridine, tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane or chloroform for example), at a temperature of between 5° C. and 20° C. and then the medium is treated with a base such as an alkali metal hydroxide (sodium hydroxide for example), an alkali metal carbonate (sodium or potassium carbonate for example), an amine such as a trialkylamine (triethylamine for example), 4-dimethylaminopyridine, diaza-1,8-bicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene, at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture. The methanesulfonyloxy and the acetyloxy may be isolated or otherwise. [0030]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R represents a chain (B) in which R′ is a hydrogen atom may be prepared by reacting the derivative R[0031] 1SO2CH2R2 (II) for which R1 and R2 have the same meanings as in formula (I) with an azetidinone of formula:
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00005
  • in which R[0032] 3 and R4 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • The procedure is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as an ether (tetrahydrofuran for example), in the presence of a strong base such as lithium diisopropylamide, potassium tert-butoxide or n-butyllithium, at a temperature of between −70° C. and −15° C. [0033]
  • The derivatives of formula (II) may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described in the examples. In particular, the procedure is carried out according to the following reaction schemes: [0034]
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00006
  • In these formulae Hal represents a halogen atom and, preferably, chlorine, bromine or iodine, R[0035] 1 and R2 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • The reaction (a) is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as dimethylformamide or a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol, at a temperature of between 20 and 30° C. [0036]
  • The reaction (b) is carried out by any known method which makes it possible to oxidize a sulfur-containing derivative without affecting the rest of the molecule such as the methods described by M. HUDLICKY, Oxidations in Organic Chemistry, ACS Monograph, 186, 252-263 (1990). For example, the procedure is carried out by the action of an organic peroxy acid or a salt of such a peroxy acid (peroxycarboxylic or peroxysulfonic acids, especially peroxybenzoic acid, 3-chloroperoxybenzoic acid, 4-nitroperoxybenzoic acid, peroxyacetic acid, trifluoroperoxyacetic acid, peroxyformic acid or monoperoxyphthalic acid) or in organic peracids or a salt of such an acid (for example periodic or persulfuric acid), in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (chloroform or dichloromethane for example), at a temperature of between 0 and 25° C. It is also possible to use hydrogen peroxide or a periodate (sodium periodate for example), in an inert solvent such as 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example), water or a mixture of these solvents, at a temperature of between 0 and 20° C. It is also possible to carry out the procedure using tert-butyl hydroperoxide in the presence of titanium tetraisopropoxide in a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example) or a water-alcohol mixture, at a temperature close to 25° C. or using oxone[0037] R (potassium peroxymonosulfate), in a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example), in the presence of water, acetic acid or sulfuric acid, at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • The reaction (c) is preferably carried out in an inert solvent such as a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example), at a temperature of between 20° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. [0038]
  • The derivatives of formula (IV) are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described in the examples. In particular, the methylated derivative or the corresponding alcohol is halogenated using a halogenating agent such as hydrobromic acid, in acetic acid, at a temperature close to 20° C. or N-bromo- or chlorosuccinimide in the presence of benzoyl peroxide, in an inert solvent such as tetrachloromethane, at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. The methylated derivatives or the corresponding alcohols are commercially available or may be obtained according to the methods described by BRINE G. A. et al., J. Heterocycl. Chem., 26, 677 (1989) and NAGARATHNAM D., Synthesis, 8, 743 (1992) and in the examples. [0039]
  • The azetidinones of formula (III) may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al., J. Heterocycl. Chem., 271 (1994) or DAVE P. R., J. Org. Chem., 61, 5453 (1996) and in the examples. The procedure is generally carried out according to the following reaction scheme: [0040]
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00007
  • In these formulae, R[0041] 3 and R4 have the same meanings as in formula (I) and X represents a chlorine or bromine atom.
  • In step A, the procedure is preferably carried out in an inert solvent such as a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (ethanol or methanol for example), optionally in the presence of an alkali metal hydroxide, at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. [0042]
  • In step B, the reduction is generally carried out using lithium aluminum hydride, in tetrahydrofuran at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. [0043]
  • In step C, the procedure is preferably carried out in an inert solvent such as a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (ethanol or methanol for example) in the presence of sodium hydrogen carbonate, at a temperature of between 20° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. [0044]
  • In step D, the oxidation is preferably carried out in DMSO, using the sulfurtrioxide-pyridine complex, at a temperature close to 20° C. or using dimethyl sulfoxide, in the presence of oxalyl chloride and triethylamine, at a temperature of between −70 and −50° C. [0045]
  • In step E, the procedure is carried out according to the method described by GRISAR M. et al., in J. Med. Chem., 885 (1973). The magnesium compound of the brominated derivative is formed and then the nitrile is reacted, in an ether such as ethyl ether, at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. After hydrolysis with an alcohol, the intermediate imine is reduced in situ with sodium borohydride at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. [0046]
  • The R[0047] 3—CO—R4 derivatives are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described by KUNDER N. G. et al. J. Chem. Soc. Perkin Trans 1, 2815 (1997); MORENO-MARRAS M., Eur. J. Med. Chem., 23 (5) 477 (1988); SKINNER et al., J. Med. Chem., 1A (6) 546 (1971); HURN N. K., Tet. Lett., M (52) 9453 (1995); MEDICI A. et al., Tet. Lett., 24 (28) 2901 (1983); RIECKE R. D. et al., J. Org. Chem., 62 (20) 6921 (1997); KNABE J. et al., Arch. Pharm., 306 (9) 648 (1973); CONSONNI R. et al., J. Chem. Soc. Perkin Trans 1, 1809 (1996); FR-96-2481 and JP-94-261393.
  • The R[0048] 3Br derivatives are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described by BRANDSMA L. et al., Synth. Comm., 20 (11) 1697 and 3153 (1990); LEMAIRE M. et al., Synth. Comm., 24 (1) 95 (1994); GODA H. et al., Synthesis, 9 849 (1992); BAEUERLE P. et al., J. Chem. Soc. Perkin Trans 2, 489 (1993).
  • The R[0049] 4CN derivatives are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described by BOUYSSOU P. et al., J. Het. Chem., 29 (4) 895 (1992); SUZUKI N. et al., J. Chem. Soc. Chem. Comm., 1523 (1984); MARBURG S. et al., J. Het. Chem., 17 1333 (1980); PERCEC V. et al., J. Org. Chem. 60 (21) 6895 (1995).
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R represents a chain (B) in which R′ is a hydrogen atom may also be prepared by action of a derivative R[0050] 3CH(Br)R4 (VI) for which R3 and R4 have the same meanings as in formula (I) with a derivative of formula:
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00008
  • in which R[0051] 1 and R2 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in the presence of a base such as an alkali metal carbonate (potassium carbonate for example), in an inert solvent such as acetonitrile, at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. [0052]
  • The derivatives of formula (VI) are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the method described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933). Generally, the corresponding alcohol R[0053] 3CHOHR4 is brominated using hydrobromic acid, in acetic acid, at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium.
  • The corresponding R[0054] 3CHOHR4 alcohols are commercially available or may be obtained by application or adaptation of the methods described by PLASZ A. C. et al., J. Chem. Soc. Chem. Comm., 527 (1972).
  • The derivatives of formula (VII) may be obtained by hydrolysis of a derivative of formula: [0055]
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00009
  • in which R[0056] 1 and R2 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out using hydrochloric acid, in an inert solvent such as an ether (dioxane for example), at a temperature close to 20° C. [0057]
  • The derivatives of formula (VIII) are obtained by reacting vinyl chloroformate with a corresponding compound of formula (1) for [lacuna] R represents a chain of formula (B), R′ represents a hydroxyl radical, R[0058] 3 and R4 are phenyl radicals, in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane or chloroform for example), at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture.
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R is a chain (B) in which R′ is a —CO-alk radical may be prepared by reacting a halide Hal-CO-alk in which Hal represents a halogen atom and, preferably, a chlorine atom and alk represents an alkyl radical with a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R is a chain (B) in which R′ is a hydrogen atom. [0059]
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as tetrahydrofuran, dioxane, a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane or chloroform for example), at a temperature of between −50° C. and 20° C., in the presence of n-butyllithium. [0060]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0061] 2 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —NR6R7 in which R6 and R7 each represent a hydrogen atom may also be prepared by reducing a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with nitro.
  • This reaction is carried out by any known method which makes it possible to reduce a nitro to an amino without affecting the rest of the molecule. Preferably, iron is used in the presence of hydrochloric acid in a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol such as ethanol, at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. [0062]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0063] 2 represents an aromatic or heteroaromatic substituted with —COHNR9 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CONR10R11 may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —COOR5 for which R5 is alkyl or phenyl optionally substituted with halogens with respectively an amine H2NR9 or HNR10R11 for which R9, R10 and R11 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane or chloroform for example) or a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example), at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture. [0064]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0065] 2 represents an aromatic substituted with hydroxyl and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with hydroxyl may also be prepared by hydrolysis of a corresponding compound of formula (1) for which R2 represents an aromatic substituted with alkoxy and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with alkoxy.
  • This reaction is carried out by any method of hydrolyzing an alkoxy to a hydroxyl without affecting the rest of the molecule. Preferably, the hydrolysis is carried out using boron tribromide, in a chlorinated solvent such as dichloromethane, at a temperature close to 20° C. [0066]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0067] 2 represents an aromatic substituted with —NR6R7 for which R6 represents an alkyl radical and R7 represents a hydrogen atom may also be prepared by deprotecting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 represents an aromatic substituted with an —N(alk)COOR8 in which R8 represents a tert-butyl radical.
  • This reaction is generally carried out using hydrochloric acid, in a solvent such as dioxane at a temperature close to 20° C. [0068]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0069] 2 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic substituted with —COOR5 may also be prepared by esterification of a derivative of formula:
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00010
  • for which R represents a chain C═C(SO[0070] 2R1)R′2 or C(OR′)CH(SO2R1)R′2, R1, R′2, R′3 and R′4 have the same meanings as the substituents R1, R2, R3 and R4 of formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R′2, R′3 and R′4 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with carboxyl, using a derivative of formula R5OH for which R5 is alkyl or phenyl optionally substituted with one or more halogens.
  • When R[0071] 5 is alkyl, this reaction is generally carried out in the presence of an inorganic acid (sulfuric acid for example), at a temperature of between 20° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. When R5 is optionally substituted phenyl, this reaction is preferably carried out in the presence of a carbodiimide (1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide or N,N′-dicyclohexylcarbodiimide for example), in an inert solvent such as an imide (dimethylformamide) or a chlorinated solvent (methylene chloride, 1,2-dichloroethane or chloroform for example), at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture.
  • The derivatives of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C═C(SO[0072] 2R1)R′2 or C(OR′)CH(SO2R1)R′2, R′, R1, R′2, R′3 and R′4 have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R1, R2, R3 and R4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R′2, R′3 and R′4 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with carboxyl may be obtained according to the methods described above for the preparation of the compounds of formula (I) from the corresponding intermediates and in particular according to the method described in Example 29.
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0073] 2 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with alkylthioalkyl may also be prepared by reaction of a derivative of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C═C(SO2R1)R′2 or C(OR′)CH(SO2R1)R′2, R′, R1, R′2, R′3 and R′4 have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R1, R2, R3 and R4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R′2, R′3 and R′4 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with haloalkyl with sodium alkylthiolate.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as an amide (dimethylformamide for example), at a temperature close to 20° C. [0074]
  • The derivatives of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C═C(SO[0075] 2R1)R′2 or C(OR′)CH(SO2R1)R′2, R′, R1, R′2, R′3 and R′4 have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R1, R2, R3 and R4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R′2, R′3 and R′4 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with haloalkyl may be obtained by reacting a phosphorus trihalide (preferably phosphorus tribromide) with a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with hydroxyalkyl, in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (carbon tetrachloride or chloroform for example), at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0076] 2 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic substituted with hydroxyalkyl in which the alkyl contains one carbon atom may also be prepared by reducing a compound of formula (I) for which at least one of the substituents R2, R3 and R4 represents an aromatic substituted with formyl.
  • This reaction is generally carried out using sodium borohydride, in a 1-4C aliphatic alcohol (methanol or ethanol for example), at a temperature close to 0° C. [0077]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0078] 3 and/or R4 represents an aromatic substituted with -alk-NR6R7 for which alk is an alkyl containing one carbon atom may also be prepared by reacting a compound of formula (I) for which at least one of the substituents R3 and R4 represents an aromatic substituted with formyl with an amine HNR6R7 in which R6 and R7 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloroethane for example), at a temperature close to 20° C. in the presence of sodium triacetoxyborohydride or sodium cyanoborohydride. [0079]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0080] 2 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CONHR9 and/or R3 and/or R4 represents an aromatic or heteroaromatic substituted with —CO—NR10R11 may also be prepared by reacting a derivative of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C═C(SO2R1)R′2 or C(OR′)CH(SO2R1)R′2, R′, R1, R′2, R′3 and R′4 have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R1, R2, R3 and R4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R′2, R′3 and R′4 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with carboxyl with respectively an amine H2NR9 or HNR10R11 in which R9, R10 and R11 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is preferably carried out in the presence of a condensing agent which is used in peptide chemistry such as a carbodiimide (for example 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide or N,N′-dicyclohexylcarbodiimide) or N,N′-carbonyldiimidazole, in an inert solvent such as an ether (tetrahydrofuran or dioxane for example), an amide (dimethylformamide) or a chlorinated solvent (methylene chloride, 1,2-dichloroethane or chloroform for example) at a temperature of between 0° C. and the boiling temperature of the reaction mixture, or after prior binding of the acid to a resin of the TFP type of formula: [0081]
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00011
  • in which S represents an aminopolystyrene resin, in an inert solvent such as dimethylformamide, in the presence of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, at a temperature close to 20° C. The binding to the resin is generally carried out in dimethylformamide, in the presence of 4-dimethylaminopyridine and 1,3-diisopropylcarbodiimide, at a temperature close to 20° C. [0082]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0083] 2 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CO—NH—NR6R7 may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —COOR5 and R5 represents an alkyl or phenyl radical optionally substituted with halogens, with a hydrazine H2N—NR6R7 for which R6 and R7 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as dimethylformamide, at a temperature close to 20° C. [0084]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0085] 2 represents an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CO—NHR9 in which R9 represents a hydrogen atom and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with —CO—NR10R11 in which R10 and R11 are hydrogen atoms may also be prepared by hydrolysis of a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 and/or R3 and/or R4 represent an aromatic or a heteroaromatic substituted with cyano.
  • This reaction is carried out by any known method which makes it possible to pass from a nitrile to the corresponding carbamoyl without affecting the rest of the molecule. Preferably, the procedure is carried out using hydrochloric acid, in acetic acid, at a temperature close to 20° C. [0086]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0087] 2 represents an aromatic substituted with —O-alk-NR12R13 may also be prepared by reacting a derivative of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C═C(SO2R1)-R′2 or C(OR′)CH(SO2R1)R′2, R′, R1, R2′, R3′ and R4′ have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R1, R2, R3 and R4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R2′, R3′ or R4′ represents an aromatic substituted with -O-alk-Hal in which alk represents an alkyl radical and Hal represents a halogen atom and, preferably, a chlorine or bromine atom, with an amine HNR12R13 in which R12R13 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as acetonitrile, in the presence of an alkali metal carbonate (potassium carbonate for example), at a temperature close to 20° C. [0088]
  • The derivatives of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C═C(SO[0089] 2R1)R′2 or C(OR′)CH(SO2R1)R′2, R′, R1, R2′, R3′ and R4′ have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R1, R2, R3 and R4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R2′, R3′ or R4′ represents an aromatic substituted with —O-alk-Hal in which alk represents an alkyl radical and Hal represents a halogen atom may be obtained by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 represents an aromatic substituted with hydroxide with a Hal-alk-Hal derivative in which Hal represents a halogen.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a ketone (methyl ethyl ketone for example), in the presence of a base such as an alkali metal carbonate (potassium carbonate for example), at the boiling temperature of the reaction medium. [0090]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0091] 3 and/or R4 represents an aromatic substituted with -alk-NR6R7 may also be prepared by reacting a derivative of formula (IX) for which R represents a chain C═C(SO2R1)R′2 or C(OR′)CH(SO2R1)R′2, R′, R1, R2′, R3′ and R4′ have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R1, R2, R3 and R4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R3′ or R4′ represents a substituted aromatic -alk-Cl in which alk represents an alkyl radical with an amine HNR6R7 in which R6R7 have the same meanings as in formula (I).
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane for example), optionally in the presence of a nitrogen base such as dimethylaminopyridine, diisopropylethylamine, at a temperature of between 5 and 25° C. [0092]
  • The derivatives of formula (IX) in which R represents a chain C═C(SO[0093] 2R1)R′2 or C(OR′)CH(SO2R1)R2, R′, R1, R2′, R3′ and R4′ have the same meanings as the substituents R′, R1, R2, R3 and R4 of the formula (I) with the proviso that at least one of the substituents R3′ or R4′ represents an aromatic substituted with -alk-Cl may be obtained by reacting thionyl chloride with a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which at least one of the substituents R3 or R4 represents an aromatic substituted with one or more hydroxyalkyl radicals.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane for example), at a temperature of between 10 and 30° C. [0094]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R represents a chain B, R′ represents a hydrogen atom and R[0095] 3 and/or R4 represents an aromatic substituted with hydroxyalkyl in which the alkyl residue contains one carbon atom may also be prepared by reacting diisobutylaluminum hydride with a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R represents a chain B, R′ represents a hydrogen atom and R3 and/or R4 represents an aromatic substituted with one or more —COOR5 radicals, in which R5 is an alkyl radical.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in toluene, at a temperature of between −30° C. and 0° C. [0096]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0097] 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with an alkyl radical may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with an alk-CHO derivative in which alk represents a straight- or branched-chain alkyl radical containing 1 to 5 carbon atoms.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloroethane or chloroform for example), in the presence of NaBH(OCOCH[0098] 3)3, at a temperature close to 20° C.
  • The compounds of formula (1) for which R[0099] 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with a radical —COOalk may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with a derivative of formula Hal-COOalk in which alk represents an alkyl radical and Hal represents a halogen atom and, preferably, a chlorine atom.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in pyridine, at a temperature close to 20° C. [0100]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0101] 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with a radical —CO—NHalk or —CS—NHalk may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with a derivative of formula Y═C═Nalk in which alk represents a straight- or branched-chain alkyl radical containing 1 to 6 carbon atoms and Y represents a sulfur or oxygen atom.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloromethane for example), at a temperature close to 20° C. [0102]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0103] 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with a radical —CO-alk-NR14R15 may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with an acid of formula R15R14N-alk-COOH in which alk represents an alkyl radical and R14 and R15 have the same meanings as in formula (I), optionally followed by deprotection of the product for which R14 is a tert-butoxycarbonyl radical in order to obtain the compounds for which R14 is a hydrogen atom.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in an inert solvent such as a chlorinated solvent (dichloroethane for example), at a temperature close to 20° C. The deprotection is carried out using formic acid at a temperature close to 20° C. [0104]
  • The compounds of formula (I) for which R[0105] 2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring substituted at the 4 position with a radical —CO-alk in which alk represents a methyl radical may also be prepared by reacting a corresponding compound of formula (I) for which R2 represents a phenyl radical substituted with a radical —NR6R7 representing a 1-piperazinyl ring with acetic anhydride.
  • This reaction is generally carried out in the presence of pyridine, at a temperature close to 20° C. [0106]
  • It is understood for persons skilled in the art that, to carry out the processes according to the invention which are described above, it may be necessary to introduce groups protecting amino, hydroxyl and carboxyl functions in order to avoid side reactions. These groups are those which allow removal without affecting the rest of the molecule. As examples of groups protecting the amino function, there may be mentioned tert-butyl or methylcarbamates which may be regenerated using iodotrimethylsilane or allyl using palladium catalysts. As examples of groups protecting the hydroxyl function, there may be mentioned triethylsilyl and tert-butyldimethylsilyl which may be regenerated using tetrabutylammonium fluoride or alternatively asymmetric acetals (methoxymethyl or tetrahydropyranyl for example) with regeneration using hydrochloric acid. As groups protecting carboxyl functions, there may be mentioned esters (allyl or benzyl for example), oxazoles and 2-alkyl-1,3-oxazolines. Other protecting groups which can be used are described by GREENE T. W. et al., Protecting Groups in Organic Synthesis, second edition, 1991, John Wiley & Sons. [0107]
  • The compounds of formula (I) may be purified by the customary known methods, for example by crystallization, chromatography or extraction. [0108]
  • The enantiomers of the compounds of formula (I) may be obtained by resolution of the racemates for example by chromatography on a chiral column according to PIRCKLE W. H. et al., Asymmetric synthesis, Vol. 1, Academic Press (1983) or by formation of salts or by synthesis from chiral precursors. The diastereoisomers may be prepared according to known conventional methods (crystallization, chromatography or from chiral precursors). [0109]
  • The compounds of formula (I) may be optionally converted to addition salts with an inorganic or organic acid by the action of such an acid in an organic solvent such as an alcohol, a ketone, an ether or a chlorinated solvent. These salts also form part of the invention. [0110]
  • As examples of pharmaceutically acceptable salts, the following salts may be mentioned: benzenesulfonate, hydrobromide, hydrochloride, citrate, ethanesulfonate, fumarate, gluconate, iodate, isethionate, maleate, methane sulfonate, methylene-bis-β-oxynaphtoate, nitrate, oxalate, pamoate, phosphate, salicylate, succinate, sulfate, tartrate, theophyllineacetate and p-toluenesulfonate. [0111]
  • The compounds of formula (I) exhibit advantageous pharmacological properties. These compounds possess a high affinity for the cannabinoid receptors and particularly those of the CB1 type. They are CBI receptor antagonists and are therefore useful in the treatment and prevention of disorders affecting the central nervous system, the immune system, the cardiovascular or endocrine system, the respiratory system, the gastrointestinal apparatus and reproductive disorders (Hollister, Pharm. Rev.; 38, 1986, 1-20, Reny and Sinha, Prog. Drug Res., 36, 71-114 (1991), Consroe and Sandyk, in Marijuana/Cannabinoids, Neurobiology and Neurophysiology, 459, Murphy L. and Barthe A. Eds, CRC Press, 1992) of bacterial, viral and parasitic infections. [0112]
  • Accordingly, these compounds may be used for the treatment or prevention of psychoses including schizophrenia, anxiety disorders, depression, epilepsy, neurodegeneration, cerebellar and spinocerebellar disorders, cognitive disorders, cranial trauma, panic attacks, peripheral neuropathies, glaucomas, migraine, Parkinson's disease, Alzeimer's disease, Huntington's chorea, Raynaud's syndrome, tremor, obsessive-compulsive disorder, senile dementia, thymic disorders, Tourette's syndrome, tardive dyskinesia, bipolar disorders, cancers, movement disorders induced by medicaments, dystonia, endotoxemic shocks, hemorrhagic shocks, hypotension, insomnia, immunological diseases, multiple sclerosis, vomiting, asthma, appetite disorders (bulimia, anorexia), obesity, memory disorders, in weaning from chronic treatments and alcohol or drug abuse (opiods, barbiturates, cannabis, cocaine, amphetamine, phencyclide, hallucinogens, benzodiazepines for example), as analgesics or potentiators of the analgesic activity of the narcotic and normarcotic drugs. They may also be used for the treatment or prevention of intestinal transit disorders, as antibacterial, antiviral and antiparasitic agents. [0113]
  • The affinity of the compounds of formula (I) for the cannabis receptors has been determined according to the method described by KUSTER J. E., STEVENSON J. I., WARD S. J., D'AMBRA T. E., HAYCOCK D. A. in J. Pharmacol. Exp. Ther., 264 1352-1363 (1993). [0114]
  • In this test, the IC[0115] 50 of the compounds of formula (I) is less than or equal to 100 nM.
  • Their antagonist activity has been shown by means of the model of hypothermia induced by an agonist of the cannabis receptors (CP-55940) in mice, according to the method described by Pertwee R. G. in Marijuana, Harvey D. J. eds, 84 Oxford IRL Press, 263-277 (1985). [0116]
  • In this text the ED50 of the compounds of formula (I) is less than or equal to 50 mg/kg. [0117]
  • The compounds of formula (I) exhibit low toxicity. Their LD[0118] 50 is greater than 40 mg/kg by the subcutaneous route in mice.
  • The preferred compounds of formula (I) are those for which [0119]
  • R represents a chain (A) or (B) and R′ represents a hydrogen atom or a —COalk radical, [0120]
  • R[0121] 1 represents a methyl or ethyl radical,
  • R[0122] 2 represents either an aromatic chosen from phenyl and naphthyl, these aromatics being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more halogens, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyl, —COOR5, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl-sulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, —NR6R7, —CO—NH—NR6R7, cyano, —CONHR9, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, nitro, —CO—NR16R17, —O-alkNR12R13 or alkylthioalkyl or a heteroaromatic chosen from isoquinolyl, pyridyl, quinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolyl and thienyl, these heteroaromatics being unsubstituted or substituted with a halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, —COOR5, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethylsulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, —NR6R7, —CO—NH—NR6R7, cyano, —CONHR9, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, nitro or alkylthioalkyl,
  • R[0123] 3 and R4, which are identical or different, represent either an aromatic chosen from phenyl or naphthyl, these aromatics being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more halogens, alkyl, alkoxy, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, —CONR10R11, -alk-NR6R7, hydroxyalkyl, formyl or —COOR5, or a heteroaromatic chosen from thiazolyl or thienyl rings, these heteroaromatics being unsubstituted or substituted with a halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, —CONR10R11, -alk-NR6R7, hydroxyalkyl or —COOR5.
  • R[0124] 5 is alkyl or phenyl which is optionally substituted with one or more halogens,
  • R[0125] 6 and R7, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl, —COOalk, cycloalkyl, alkylcycloalkyl, -alk-O-alk or hydroxyalkyl radical or alternatively R6 and R7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk, —CO-alk-NR14R15, oxo, hydroxyalkyl, alk-O-alk or —CO—NH2 radicals,
  • R[0126] 9 represents a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or an alkyl radical substituted with dialkylamino, phenyl, cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with —COOalk) or a 3-to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing one or more heteroatoms chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl radicals,
  • R[0127] 10 and R11, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or alternatively R10 and R11 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl radical,
  • R[0128] 12 and R13, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or cycloalkyl radical or alternatively R12 and R13 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 radical or a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing a heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen,
  • R[0129] 14 and R15, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or —COOalk radical,
  • R[0130] 16 and R17 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing
  • another heteroatom chosen from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, [0131]
  • alk represents an alkyl or alkylene radical, [0132]
  • their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid. [0133]
  • The compounds of formula (I) which are particularly preferred are those for which [0134]
  • R represents a chain (A) or (B), [0135]
  • R′ representing a hydrogen atom or a radical —COalk, [0136]
  • R[0137] 1 represents a methyl or ethyl radical,
  • R[0138] 2 represents either an aromatic chosen from
  • naphthyl, [0139]
  • phenyl, [0140]
  • phenyl substituted with one or more halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyl, —COOR[0141] 5 (in which R5 represents an alkyl or phenyl radical optionally substituted with several halogens) trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethyl-sulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, —NR6R7 (in which R6 and R7, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl or —COOalk radical or alternatively R6 and R7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a heterocycle chosen from pyrrolidinyl, piperidyl, piperazinyl or piperazinyl substituted with one or more alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 radicals, in which R14 and R15, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical), —CO—NH—NR6R7 (R6 and R7, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or alternatively R6 and R7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a heterocycle chosen from piperidyl, piperazinyl or piperazyl substituted with one or more alkyl radicals), cyano, —CONHR9 (in which R9 represents a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or an alkyl radical substituted with dialkylamino, phenyl, cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with —COOalk) or a heterocycle chosen from pyrrolidinyl (optionally substituted with alkyl), tetrahydrofuryl, or morpholinyl), alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, nitro, —CO—NR16R17, (in which R16 and R17 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a piperidyl ring), —O-alkNR12R13 (in which R12 and R13 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a morpholino ring) or alkylthioalkyl, or a heteroaromatic chosen from
  • isoquinolyl, [0142]
  • pyridyl, [0143]
  • quinolyl, [0144]
  • 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolyl, [0145]
  • 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolyl, [0146]
  • thienyl, or [0147]
  • thienyl substituted with a —COOR[0148] 5 (in which R5 represents an alkyl radical) or —CONHR9, (in which R9 represents an alkyl radical),
  • R[0149] 3 and R4, which are identical or different, represent either an aromatic chosen from
  • phenyl or [0150]
  • phenyl substituted with one or more halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, hydroxyalkyl, formyl, —COOR[0151] 5 (in which R5 is an alkyl radical), —CONR10R11 (in which R10 and R11, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical), -alk-NR6R7 (in which R6 and R7, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl, cycloalkyl, -alk-O-alk or hydroxyalkyl radical or alternatively R6 and R7 together form with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached a heterocycle chosen from piperidyl (optionally substituted with alkyl or oxo), pyrrolidinyl (optionally substituted with alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-O-alk or —CO—NH2), thiomorpholinyl, morpholinyl, pyrrolyl, piperazinyl optionally substituted with oxo, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, —COOR5 (in which R5 is an alkyl radical),
  • or a heteroaromatic chosen from [0152]
  • thiazolyl or [0153]
  • thienyl, [0154]
  • alk represents an alkyl or alkylene radical, [0155]
  • their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid. [0156]
  • Preferably, R[0157] 2 is a substituted phenyl radical, the latter is monosubstituted and, in particular, at the 3-position or alternatively disubstituted and, in particular at the 3,5, 2,5 or 2,3-positions.
  • Preferably, when R[0158] 3 is a substituted phenyl radical, the latter is monosubstituted and, in particular, at the 4-position or disubstituted and, in particular, at the 2,4-positions.
  • Preferably, when R[0159] 4 is a substituted phenyl radical, the latter is monosubstituted and, in particular, at the 4-position or disubstituted and, in particular, at the 2,4-positions.
  • The following compounds may be mentioned among the preferred compounds: [0160]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine, [0161]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0162]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0163]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0164]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0165]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0166]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0167]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0168]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0169]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-iodophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0170]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methylene]azetidine, [0171]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)methylene]azetidine, [0172]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)-methylene} azetidine, [0173]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dibromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0174]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0175]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0176]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0177]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-carbamoylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0178]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-1-yl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene] azetidine, [0179]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0180]
  • 1-[bis(4-methoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0181]
  • 1-[bis(4-methylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0182]
  • (RS)-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl)] azetidine, [0183]
  • (R)-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl)] azetidine, [0184]
  • (S)-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl)]azetidine, [0185]
  • 1-[bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0186]
  • 1-[bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0187]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[(3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)-phenyl]methylsulfonylmethylene} azetidine, [0188]
  • (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0189]
  • (R)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0190]
  • (S)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0191]
  • (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0192]
  • (R)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0193]
  • (S)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0194]
  • (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(pyrrolidylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0195]
  • (R)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(pyrrolidylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0196]
  • (S)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(pyrrolidylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0197]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(3,3-dimethylpiperidin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0198]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(3,3-dimethylpiperidin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0199]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(3,3-dimethylpiperidin-1 yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0200]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(thiomorpholin-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0201]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(thiomorpholin-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0202]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(thiomorpholin-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0203]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethyl-N-cyclohexylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0204]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethyl-N-cyclohexylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0205]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethyl-N-cyclohexylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0206]
  • 1-{{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[(4-ethoxycarbonylpiperazinyl)-methyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0207]
  • 1-{{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[(4-ethoxycarbonylpiperazinyl)-methyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0208]
  • 1-{{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[(4-ethoxycarbonylpiperazinyl)-methyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0209]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(N-cyclopropyl-N-propyl-aminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0210]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(N-cyclopropyl-N-propyl-aminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0211]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-cyclopropyl-N-propyl-aminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0212]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diisopropylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0213]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diisopropylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0214]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diisopropylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0215]
  • 1-{{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[bis-(2-methoxyethyl)aminomethyl]-phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0216]
  • 1-{{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[bis-(2-methoxyethyl)aminomethyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0217]
  • 1-{{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl){4-[bis-(2-methoxyethyl)aminomethyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0218]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(di-n-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0219]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(di-n-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0220]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(di-n-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0221]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0222]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0223]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0224]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0225]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0226]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0227]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(morpholin-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0228]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(morpholin-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0229]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(morpholin-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0230]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0231]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(diethylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0232]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0233]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperazin-2-on-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0234]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperazin-2-on-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0235]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperazin-2-on-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0236]
  • 1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(imidazol-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0237]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(imidazol-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0238]
  • 1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(imidazol-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0239]
  • (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N,N-dimethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0240]
  • (R)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N,N-dimethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0241]
  • (S)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N,N-dimethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0242]
  • (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0243]
  • (R)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0244]
  • (S)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0245]
  • (RS)-1-[(4-carbamoylphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0246]
  • (R)-1-[(4-carbamoylphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0247]
  • (S)-1-[(4-carbamoylphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0248]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0249]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0250]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylmethyl)phenyl)]-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0251]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0252]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carbamoylphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0253]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0254]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-hydroxyphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0255]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methylsulfonyl)-(3-pyrrolidinylphenyl)methylene]azetidine, [0256]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-hydroxymethyl-phenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine, [0257]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(N-piperidylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methylene} azetidine, [0258]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)-(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine, [0259]
  • 1-[bis(4-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0260]
  • 1-[bis(2-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0261]
  • 1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0262]
  • (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine, [0263]
  • (R)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine, [0264]
  • (S)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine, [0265]
  • (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0266]
  • (R)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0267]
  • (S)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0268]
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(ethylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene] azetidine, [0269]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{{3-[N-(4-methylpiperazinyl)carbamoyl]phenyl}(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0270]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(2,2-dimethylcarbohydrazido)-phenyl] (methylsulfonyl)methylene} azetidine, [0271]
  • 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine, [0272]
  • 1-[bis(p-tolyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine, [0273]
  • 1-[4-chlorophenyl)(4-hydroxymethylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0274]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methylaminophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0275]
  • (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0276]
  • (R)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0277]
  • (S)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine, [0278]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-methoxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methylene]azetidine, [0279]
  • -1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-hydroxy-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-methoxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methyl]azetidine (RS), [0280]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(2-isobutylaminocarbonylthien-5-yl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0281]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxycarbonyl-phenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)azetidin-3-ol, [0282]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(pyridin-4-yl)methyl-(RS)azetidin-3-ol, [0283]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(pyridin-3-yl)methyl-(RS)azetidin-3-ol, [0284]
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-morpholin-4-yl-propyl)benzamide, [0285]
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)benzamide, [0286]
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-pyrrolidin-1-ylethyl)benzamide, [0287]
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-dimethylamino-1-methylethyl)benzamide, [0288]
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-piperidin-1-ylbenzamide, [0289]
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-isobutylbenzamide, [0290]
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-imidazol-1-ylpropyl)benzamide, [0291]
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-dimethylaminoethyl)benzamide, [0292]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid N′-methylhydrazide, [0293]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-morpholin-4-ylethyl)benzamide, [0294]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(1-ethylpyrrolidin-2-ylmethyl)benzamide, [0295]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2,2-dimethylpropyl)benzamide, [0296]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-cyclohexylmethylbenzamide, [0297]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-cyclopropylmethylbenzamide, [0298]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-methylbutyl)benzamide, [0299]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-phenylpropyl)benzamide, [0300]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(tetrahydrofuran-2-ylmethyl)benzamide, [0301]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2,2-diphenylethyl)benzamide, [0302]
  • 3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-ethylbutyl)benzamide, [0303]
  • 4-{[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoylamino]methyl} cyclohexanecarboxylic acid methyl ester, [0304]
  • 2-amino-1-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl]methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}ethanone, [0305]
  • (2-{4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-oxoethyl)carbamic acid tert-butyl ester, [0306]
  • 1-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-methylaminoethanone, [0307]
  • (2-{4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-oxoethyl)-N-methylcarbamic acid tert-butyl ester, [0308]
  • 4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carbothioic acid N-methylamide, [0309]
  • 4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid N-methylamide, [0310]
  • 4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid methyl ester, [0311]
  • 1-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]-4-isobutylpiperazine, [0312]
  • 1-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]-4-ethylpiperazine, [0313]
  • 4-acetyl 1-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine, [0314]
  • 1-{4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-dimethylaminoethanone, [0315]
  • 1-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine, [0316]
  • 4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester, [0317]
  • 1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0318]
  • 3-acetoxy-1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)azetidine, [0319]
  • (RS)-4-[4-((4-chlorophenyl){3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-methanesulfonylmethylene]azetidin-1-yl}methyl)benzyl]morpholine, [0320]
  • 4-(4-{3-[(1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-ylidene)methanesulfonylmethyl]phenoxy}butyl)morpholine, [0321]
  • 4-(4-{3-[(1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-ylidene)methanesulfonylmethyl]phenoxy}propyl)morpholine, [0322]
  • their optical isomers and their esters. [0323]
  • Among these compounds, the following compounds are particularly preferred; [0324]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, [0325]
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, [0326]
  • 3-acetoxy-1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)methyl-sulfonylmethyl(RS)]azetidine their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid. [0327]
  • The following examples illustrate the invention without limiting it. [0328]
  • Example 1
  • 0.3 cm[0329] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride is added to a solution of 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol in 10 cm3 of pyridine, cooled to 5° C. The mixture is stirred for 2 hours at 5° C. and then 1 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine is added in 10 cm3 of dichloromethane at 5° C. The solution is stirred for 15 hours at room temperature and then concentrated to a dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chomatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and collecting 80 cm3 fractions. Fractions 17 to 20 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is crystallized from 10 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.14 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 210° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), between 7.40 and 7.60 (9H, m, 9 CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: 6.25 cm[0330] 3 of 1.6 N n-butyllithium in solution in hexane are added to a solution of 1.4 cm3 of diisopropylamine in 10 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran, under an argon atmosphere, cooled to 0° C., and then the mixture is cooled to −70° C. A mixture of 1.7 g of benzyl methyl sulfone in 30 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran are then added and the stirring is maintained for 45 minutes at −70° C. 2.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one are added and then the mixture is stirred for 20 minutes while allowing the mixture to return to room temperature. The reaction mixture is filtered and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is taken up in 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate, 30 cm3 of water and 20 cm3 of normal hydrochloric acid. The precipitate is filtered, washed with 30 cm3 of distilled water, drained and dried. 2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained melting at 260° C.
  • 1-Benzhydrylazetidin-3-one may be prepared according to the procedure described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al. in J. Heterocycl. Chem., 271 (1994). [0331]
  • Example 2
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 1.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.52 cm[0332] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.7 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 17 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (98.5/1.5 by volume) as eluents and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 5 and 6 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 2 cm3 of dichloromethane and 20 cm3 of diisopropyl ether. 0.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 180° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.35 (3H, s, PhCH3), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (5H, m, 5CH arom.), 7.30 (5H, t, J=7 Hz, 5CH arom.), 7.50 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.8 g of methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfone and 3.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.6 g of a solid are obtained after purification on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (98.5/1.5 by volume) as eluent. The solid is taken up in 25 cm[0333] 3 of diisopropyl ether. After filtration, draining and drying, 1.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained melting at 170° C.
  • Methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: 10.5 g of oxone[0334] R and then 2.6 g of methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfide and 30 cm3 of ethanol are added, at room temperature, to a solution of 30 cm3 of water, 30 cm3 of acetic acid and 15 cm3 of 36 N sulfuric acid. The mixture is stirred for 48 hours at room temperature and then taken up in 100 cm3 of water and 100 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is washed with a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution, decanted off, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 2.8 g of methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a gum.
  • Methyl(3-methylbenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: 1.7 g of sodium methylthiolate are added, while the temperature is kept below 30° C., to a solution of 3.7 g of 3-methylbenzyl bromide in 25 cm[0335] 3 of dimethylformamide. The mixture is stirred for 2 hours at a temperature close to 20° C. and then taken up in 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is washed with 3 times 100 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 2.6 g of methyl(3-methyl-benzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • Example 3
  • 0.3 cm[0336] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride is added to a solution of 3.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol in 10 cm3 of pyridine, cooled to 5° C. The mixture is stirred for 2 hours at 5° C. and then 1 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine is added in 10 cm3 of dichloromethane at 5° C. The solution is stirred for 15 hours at room temperature and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and collecting 80 cm3 fractions. Fractions 17 to 20 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 30 cm3 of acetonitrile. 0.14 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 210° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.30 (3H, s, PhCH3), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (4H, m, 4CH arom.), 7.30 (6H, t, J=7 Hz, 6CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfone and 5.1 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained melting at 226° C. [0337]
  • Methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.5 g of methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfide and 12.3 g of oxone[0338] R, 3.5 g of methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5.6 g of 4-methylbenzyl bromide and 2.3 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.7 g of methyl(4-methylbenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of a solid. [0339]
  • Example 4
  • 0.7 cm[0340] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and then 3.8 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine are added to a solution of 3.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol in 50 cm3 of dichloromethane, at room temperature. The solution is stirred for 3 hours under reflux and then taken up in twice 50 cm3 of water. The organic phase is decanted off, dried and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99/1 by volume mixture) and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 6 to 17 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 50 cm3 of ethyl ether. 2.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a foam [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.30 (3H, s, PhCH3), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.50 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH) between 7.10 and 7.35 (10H, m, 10CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, m, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.4 g of methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfone and 4.3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained melting at 218° C. [0341]
  • Methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: by carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.5 g of methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfide and 16.2 g of oxone[0342] R, 3.4 g of methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 but starting with 5.6 g of 2-methylbenzyl bromide and 2.1 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.5 g of methyl(2-methylbenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of a solid. [0343]
  • Example 5
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 but starting with 2.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.55 cm[0344] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 2.3 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 18 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 3 cm3 of dichloromethane and 40 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 204° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.60 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (7H, m, 7CH arom.), 7.55 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (2-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, the residue obtained is taken up in 50 cm[0345] 3 of ethyl acetate, filtered and dried. 2.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (2-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.4 g of (2-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 12 g of oxone[0346] R, 4 g of (2-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of an oil which crystallizes.
  • (2-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 but starting with 4 g of 2-chlorobenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.4 g of (2-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0347]
  • Example 6
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.79 cm[0348] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3.3 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 2 to 5 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 40 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.7 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 205° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (8H, m, 8CH arom.)].
  • 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.1 g of (3-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 3.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0349]
  • (3-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.2 g of (3-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 12 g of oxone[0350] R, 3.2 g of (3-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4 g of 3-chlorobenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.2 g of 3-chlorobenzylmethylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0351]
  • Example 7
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 3.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.87 cm[0352] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3.6 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 8 to 12 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 3 cm3 and 30 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 192° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), between 7.40 and 7.55 (8H, m, 8CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.8 g of (4-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 3.24 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid after crystallization from 80 cm[0353] 3.
  • (4-Chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.5 g of (4-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 12.3 g of oxone[0354] R, 3.5 g of (4-chlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Example 8
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 3.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.75 cm[0355] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3.1 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 6 to 10 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 2 cm3 of dichloromethane and 30 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 204° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.85 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (6H, m, 6CH arom.), 7.70 (1H, s, CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (3,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0356]
  • (3,5-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5.3 g of (3,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 17 g of oxone[0357] R , 5 g of (3,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,5-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of 3,5-dichlorobenzyl chloride and 2 g of sodium methylthiolate, 5.3 g of (3,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0358]
  • Example 9
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.2 cm[0359] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3.8 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (70/30 by volume) as eluent and collecting 35 cm3 fractions. Fractions 30 to 55 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 50 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 170° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), between 7.35 and 7.50 (5H, m, 5CH arom.), 7.65 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4.5 g of (3,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,4-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0360]
  • (3,4-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.3 g of (3,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone[0361] R , 4.7 g of (3,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,4-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.8 cm[0362] 3 of 3,4-dichlorobenzyl chloride and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.3 g of (3,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • Example 10
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 1.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.4 cm[0363] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.8 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 8 to 14 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 2 cm3 of dichloromethane and 30 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 202° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.70 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), between 7.55 and 7.70 (3H, m, 3CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 1.2 g of (2,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 1.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0364]
  • (2,5-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: 1.9 g of sodium methanesulfinate are added, at room temperature, to a solution of 2.7 g of 2,5-dichlorobenzyl chloride in 30 cm[0365] 3 of ethanol. The mixture is heated under reflux for 5 hours, cooled to room temperature and then taken up in 50 cm3 of water and 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is decanted off, washed with 20 cm of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.2 g of (2,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Example 11
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 9.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,4-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 2.2 cm[0366] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 7 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5.5 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 40 cm3 fractions. Fractions 27 to 39 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 20 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,4-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 165° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.65 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (6H, m, 6CH arom.), 7.80 (1H, s, CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,4-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4.8 g of (2,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.7 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 9.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,4-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a brown foam. [0367]
  • (2,4-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4 g of (2,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone[0368] R, 4.8 g of (2,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 111° C.
  • (2,4-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.8 cm[0369] 3 of 2,4-dichlorobenzyl chloride and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4 g of (2,4-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • Example 12
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.1 g of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (98/2 by volume) as eluent and collecting 100 cm[0370] 3 fractions. Fractions 10 to 20 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 40 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 201° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.60 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (6H, m, 6CH arom.), 7.70 (1H, dd, J=8 and 2 Hz, CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.6 g of (2,3-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 3.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 5.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)] azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0371]
  • (2,3-Dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 3 g of 2,3-dichlorobenzyl chloride and 2.4 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 3.6 g of (2,3-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfonate are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0372]
  • Example 13
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 2.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.72 cm[0373] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 2.9 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent, collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 2 to 6 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 40 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 210° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.10 and 7.30 (9H, m, 9CH arom.), 7.45 (5H, m, 5CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.6 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone and 3.3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 200° C. [0374]
  • (3-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.1 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide and 13 g of oxone[0375] R, 2.7 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.6 cm[0376] 3 of 3-fluorobenzyl bromide and 1.6 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.1 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • Example 14
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 4.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-fluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.2 cm[0377] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3.7 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.5 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 30 cm3 fractions. Fractions 28 to 58 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 100 cm3 of ethyl ether. 2.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 188° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.65 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (6H, m, 6CH arom.), 7.50 (6H, m, 6CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.4 g of 2-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone and 4.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0378]
  • (2-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 R starting with 3 g of 2-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide and 13 g of oxone[0379] R, 3.6 g of 3-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (2-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.4 cm[0380] 3 of 2-fluorobenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3 g of 2-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • Example 15
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.3 cm[0381] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.9 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 30 cm3 fractions. Fractions 20 to 35 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 50 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine are obtained melting at 186° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.15 and 7.35 (8H, m, 8CH arom.), 7.45 (6H, m, 6CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.8 g of 4-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone and 3.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a white solid. [0382]
  • (4-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3 g of 4-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide and 13 g of oxone[0383] R, 3 g of 4-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 110° C.
  • (4-Fluorobenzyl) methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.5 cm[0384] 3 of 4-fluorobenzyl chloride and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3 g of 4-fluorobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • Example 16
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 3.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1 cm[0385] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 4.2 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent, collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 5 to 10 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 30 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 172° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.85 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.10 and 7.40 (9H, m, 9CH arom.), 7.50 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.2 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl methyl sulfone and 3.7 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0386]
  • (3,5-Difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.2 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl methyl sulfide and 16 g of oxone[0387] R, 3.3 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,5-Difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl bromide and 2 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.9 g of 3,5-difluorobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0388]
  • Example 17
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 5.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 2.3 cm[0389] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 7.3 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 6 cm, height 40 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and methanol (98/2 by volume) as eluent and collecting 50 cm3 fractions. Fractions 65 to 87 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 75 cm3 of ethyl ether. 2.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 208° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (400 MHz): 3.05 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.70 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.15 and 7.55 (13H, m, 13CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (2,3-difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone and 4.8 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 5.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-difluorophenyl)(methyl-sulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a beige solid. [0390]
  • (2,3-Difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 4.1 g of 2,3-difluorobenzyl bromide and 4.1 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 4 g of (2,3-difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0391]
  • Example 18
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 5.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 2.3 cm[0392] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 7.3 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 6 cm, height 40 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and methanol (98/2 by volume) as eluent and collecting 50 cm3 fractions. Fractions 73 to 90 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 75 cm3 of ethyl ether. 2.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 176° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (2,5-difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone and 4.8 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 5.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a cream-colored solid. [0393]
  • (2,5-Difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 4.1 g of 2,5-difluorobenzyl bromide and 4.1 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 4.8 g of (2,5-difluorobenzyl) methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 95° C. [0394]
  • Example 19
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 7.7 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.8 cm[0395] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 5.8 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99.5/0.5 by volume) as eluents and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 17 to 28 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 5 cm3 of dichloromethane and 50 cm3 of ethyl ether. 3.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 200° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), between 7.35 and 7.55 (6H, m, 6CH arom.), 7.65 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 8 g of 3-bromobenzyl methyl sulfone and 7.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0396]
  • 3-Bromobenzyl methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 9 g of 3-bromobenzyl methyl sulfide and 27 g of oxone[0397] R, 8.2 g of 3-bromobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 3-Bromobenzyl methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 10 g of 3-bromobenzyl bromide and 3.1 g of sodium methylthiolate, 9 g of 3-bromobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0398]
  • Example 20
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 1.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-iodophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.3 cm[0399] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.4 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (99.7/0.3 by volume) as eluents and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 16 to 24 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 1.5 cm3 of dichloromethane and 25 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-iodophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 198° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.10 and 7.30 (7H, m, 7CH arom.), 7.45 (5H, m, 5CH arom.), 7.80 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-iodophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.7 g of 3-iodobenzyl methyl sulfone and 3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-iodophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0400]
  • 3-Iodobenzyl methyl sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.6 g of 3-iodobenzyl methyl sulfide and 10.3 g of oxone[0401] R, 3.7 g of 3-iodobenzyl methyl sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 3-Iodobenzyl methyl sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of 3-iodobenzyl bromide and 1.3 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4 g of 3-iodobenzyl methyl sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0402]
  • Example 21
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 2.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.6 cm[0403] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 2.3 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (99.7/0.3 by volume) as eluents and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 25 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 2 cm3 of dichloromethane and 30 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.7 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 162° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.15 and 7.40 (6H, m, 6CH arom.), between 7.45 and 7.55 (7H, m, 7CH arom.), 7.60 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2.4 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfone and 2.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0404]
  • Methyl(3-fluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 2.6 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfide and 7.2 g of oxone[0405] R, 2.4 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3 g of 3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl bromide and 1 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.3 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethoxybenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0406]
  • Example 22
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 4.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1 cm[0407] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 4.2 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent, collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 10 to 14 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 2 cm3 of dichloromethane and 30 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 178° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.15 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), between 7.60 and 7.80 (4H, m, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.4 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfone and 3.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0408]
  • Methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.3 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfide and 10 g of oxone[0409] R, 3.4 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.9 g of 3-trifluoromethylbenzyl bromide and 1.4 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.3 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylbenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0410]
  • Example 23
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 2.7 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-ol, 0.6 cm[0411] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 2.4 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 6 cm, height 40 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent, collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 7 to 12 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 10 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-(methylsulfonyl)methylene}azetidine is obtained melting at 192° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.85 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.15 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), 7.15 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.40 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 8.05 (2H, s, 2CH arom.), 8.15 (1H, s, CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-{[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)-methylene}azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.1 g of methyl[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl]sulfone and 2.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[(3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)-methylene}azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0412]
  • Methyl[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 3 g of 3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl chloride and 2 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 3.1 g of methyl[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl]sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 132° C. [0413]
  • Example 24
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 10.7 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dibromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 2.2 cm[0414] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 7 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5.5 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 35 cm3 fractions. Fractions 40 to 58 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 50 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[3,5-dibromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 209° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.88 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.22 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.22 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.33 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.48 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.68 (2H, s, 2CH arom.), 7.95 (1H, s, CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dibromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 6.2 g of (3,5-dibromobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.5 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 10.7 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[3,5-dibromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam. [0415]
  • (3,5-Dibromobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5.8 g of (3,5-dibromobenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone[0416] R, 6.2 g of (3,5-dibromobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3,5-Dibromobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 6.6 g of 3,5-dibromobenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 5.8 g of (3,5-dibromobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0417]
  • Example 25
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 4.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-nitrophenyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.1 cm[0418] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 2.5 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (50/50 by volume) as eluents, collecting 400 cm3 fractions. Fractions 17 to 33 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is recrystallized from 15 cm3 of ethyl acetate. 0.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-nitrophenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 184° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.85 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.75 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.85 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 8.25 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-nitrophenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.9 g of methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfone and 4.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-nitrophenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam. [0419]
  • Methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 but starting with 18.1 g of methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfide and 68 g of oxone[0420] R, 13.9 g of methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • Methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 17.2 g of 3-nitrobenzyl chloride and 7.7 g of sodium methylthiolate, 18.2 g of methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0421]
  • Example 26
  • A mixture of 0.34 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)-(3-nitrophenyl)methylene]azetidine, 16 cm[0422] 3 of 1 N hydrochloric acid in 8 cm3 of ethanol and 16 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran is heated under reflux. 0.17 g of iron powder is added and the reflux is maintained for 3 hours. The mixture is then cooled to room temperature and the insoluble matter is filtered off. The solution is taken up in 10 cm3 of 1 N sodium hydroxide and 50 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution. The aqueous phase is extracted with 3 times 40 cm3 of dichloromethane, the extracts are combined, dried over sodium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is purified on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (50/50 by volume) as eluent, collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 13 to 31 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 15 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.17 g of 3-[(3-aminophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-1-benzhydrylazetidine is obtained melting at 197° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 5.25 (2H, s, NH2), 6.55 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.05 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • Example 27
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 1.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.3 cm[0423] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.3 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a mixture of dichloromethane and ethyl acetate (99.5/0.5 by volume) as eluents and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fraction 18 is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is precipitated in 5 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.13 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a foamy solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.60 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.70 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 8.00 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3 g of (3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfone and 3.6 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam after purification by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99/1 by volume) as eluents. [0424]
  • (3-Methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.3 g of (3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfide and 13.4 g of oxone[0425] R, 3.4 g of (3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of 3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl bromide and 1.7 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.3 g of (3-methoxycarbonylbenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0426]
  • Example 28
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 6.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.6 cm[0427] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 6.8 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a dichloromethane and ethyl acetate mixture (99.5/0.5 by volume) as eluents and collecting 250 cm3 fractions. Fractions 10 to 15 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 5 cm3 of dichloromethane and 70 cm3 of ethyl ether. 2.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine are obtained melting at 152° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.65 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.75 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.90 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.9 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.7 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 6.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0428]
  • (3-Cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 6.7 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfide and 27.6 g of oxone[0429] R, 3.9 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • (3-Cyanobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 8 g of 3-cyanobenzyl bromide and 3.1 g of sodium methylthiolate, 6.8 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0430]
  • Example 29
  • A mixture of 3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine hydrochloride, 1.3 g of pentafluorophenol, 1.4 g of 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide in 30 cm[0431] 3 of dimethylformamide is stirred at room temperature for 15 hours. The mixture is taken up in 100 cm3 of water and 100 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution and 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is decanted off, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (99.4/0.6 by volume) as eluents and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 13 to 16 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 10 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pentafluorophenoxy-carbonylphenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 182° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (400 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.85 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.70 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 8.20 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine hydrochloride may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 10 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 40 cm[0432] 3 of acetic acid and 40 cm3 of concentrated hydrochloric acid (d=1.18) is heated at 45° C. for 7 days. The reaction medium is cooled on an ice-cold water bath and the precipitate formed is filtered on sintered glass. The solid is washed with 20 cm3 of a mixture of acetic acid and concentrated hydrochloric acid (50-50 by volume) and then with 3 times 20 cm3 of water and finally with 20 cm3 of ethanol. The white solid obtained is under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa) at 45° C. and 2.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine hydrochloride are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Example 30
  • A solution of 0.65 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pentafluorophenoxycarbonylphenyl)methylene]azetidine in 25 cm[0433] 3 of 6.2 N ammoniacal ethanol is stirred for 4 hours at room temperature. The mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa) and then the residue is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99/1 by volume) and then a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (98/2 by volume) as eluents and collecting 60 cm3 fractions. Fractions 18 to 30 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-carbamoylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 140° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.25 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), between 7.45 and 7.65 (7H, m, 6CH arom. and 2 CONH2), 7.95 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 8.10 (1H, s, 2 CONH2).
  • Example 31
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 4.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.2 cm[0434] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3.8 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 2.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained, after recrystallization from 150 cm3 of acetonitrile, melting at 179° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.75 (3H, s, OCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.00 (3H, m, 3 CH arom.), between 7.20 and 7.12 (11H, m, 10OH phenyls and 1CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.4 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone and 4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0435]
  • (3-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.4 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone[0436] R, 4 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 71° C.
  • (3-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.1 g of 3-methoxybenzyl bromide and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.4 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0437]
  • Example 32
  • 10 cm[0438] 3 of a 1 M solution of boron tetrabromide in dichloromethane are added, with stirring, to a solution of 1.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 100 cm3 of dichloromethane. The stirring is maintained for 16 hours at room temperature. The reaction medium is taken up in 100 cm3 of ice-cold water. The organic phase is washed with 3 times 50 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is precipitated in 150 cm3 of isopropyl ether and then dissolved in 50 cm3 of dichloromethane. The organic phase is washed with 3 times 30 cm3 of a saturated aqueous solution of sodium bicarbonate, decanted off, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is precipitated in 80 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.36 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-hydroxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained from a solid melting at 248° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 6.85 (3H, m, 3 CH arom.), 7.25 (3H, m, 3 CH arom.), 7.35 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.50 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 9.50 (1H, s, OH)].
  • Example 33
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 32 starting with 1.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, 10 cm[0439] 3 of a 1 M boron tribromide solution and 100 cm3 of dichloromethane, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3.5 cm, height 24 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (50/50 by volume) as eluents and collecting 25 cm3 fractions. Fractions 21 to 37 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from a mixture of 30 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-hydroxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 211° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.90 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 6.80 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), between 7.10 and 7.35 (8H, m, 8CH arom.), 7.48 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 9.80 (1H, s, OH)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 3.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.9 cm[0440] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 2.9 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by recrystallization from 100 cm3 of acetonitrile. 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 181° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.5 g of (4-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone and 4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 3.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0441]
  • (4-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.4 g of (4-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide and 13 g of oxone[0442] R, 3.5 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 113° C.
  • (4-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 3.1 g of 4-methoxybenzyl chloride and 1.5 g of sodium methylthiolate, 3.4 g of (4-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0443]
  • Example 34
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 32 starting with 1.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, 10 cm[0444] 3 of a 1 M solution of boron tribromide and 100 cm3 of dichloromethane, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 40 cm3 fractions. Fractions 15 to 34 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 40 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.7 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-hydroxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 196° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.60 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 6.85 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 6.90 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.20 (4H, m, 4CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.48 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 9.90 (1H, s, OH)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 4.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.1 cm[0445] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3.5 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethyl acetate (50/50 by volume) as eluents and collecting 40 cm3 fractions. Fractions 23 to 54 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 40 cm3 of ethyl ether. 1.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 204° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4 g of (2-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone and 4.5 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(2-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a brown foam. [0446]
  • (2-Methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 3.1 g of (2-methoxybenzyl) chloride and 4.1 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 4 g of (2-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0447]
  • Example 35
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 2.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.5 cm[0448] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 2.2 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 6 to 10 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 20 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-2-yl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 178° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (4H, m, 4CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.52 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.90 (4H, m, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.5 g of methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfone and 3.8 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 2.2 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 196° C. [0449]
  • Methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4.2 g of methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfide and 13.7 g of oxone[0450] R, 3.6 g of methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a cream-colored solid.
  • Methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 5 g of (2-bromomethyl)naphthalene and 1.8 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.2 g of methyl(naphth-2-ylmethyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0451]
  • Example 36
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 4.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-1-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.1 cm[0452] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 4.6 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 6 to 14 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 30 cm3 of ethyl ether. 2.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-1-yl)methylene] azetidine are obtained melting at 196° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.35 and 3.50 (1H each, dd, J=16 and 3 Hz, NCH2), 4.35 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.10 and 7.70 (14H, m, 14CH arom.), 8.00 (3H, m, 3CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-1-yl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 4.1 g of methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfone and 4.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 4.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-1-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a solid. [0453]
  • Methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 R starting with 4.3 g of methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfide and 13.9 g of oxone[0454] R, 4.1 g of methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 4 g of 1-chloromethylnaphthalene chloride and 1.8 g of sodium methylthiolate, 4.5 g of methyl(naphth-1-ylmethyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil. [0455]
  • Example 37
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 0.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pyrrolidinophenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.15 cm[0456] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.6 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (98/2 by volume) as eluents and collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 8 to 13 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 8 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.36 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)-(3-pyrrolidinophenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 153° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 1.95 (4H, m, 2 CH2), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.20 (4H, m, 2 NCH2), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 6.60 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.20 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.48 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pyrrolidinophenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 0.77 g of 3-pyrrolidinobenzyl methyl sulfone and 0.76 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 0.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pyrrolidinophenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a solid. [0457]
  • Methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 1 g of methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfide and 3.3 g of oxone[0458] R, 0.8 g of methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfone is obtained in the form of a solid.
  • Methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfide may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 2 g of (3-iodobenzyl)methylsulfide, 1.3 cm[0459] 3 of pyrrolidine, 1.1 g of sodium tert-butoxide, 0.28 g of 1,1′-bis(diphenylphosphino)-ferrocenyl palladium chloride, 0.63 g of 1,1′-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene and 60 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran is heated under reflux, under a nitrogen stream, for 3 hours. The reaction medium is cooled to room temperature and filtered on sintered glass. The precipitate is washed with 20 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran and 10 cm3 of dichloromethane and then the filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is taken up with 30 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 30 cm3 of 3 N hydrochloric acid. The aqueous phase is decanted off, neutralized (pH=7-8) with 35 cm3 of 3 N sodium hydroxide and taken up in 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is extracted; 4 g of silica are added and then the mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.5 kPa). The powder obtained is eluted on sintered glass containing 20 g of silica with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (90/10 by volume). The filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.2 g of methyl(3-pyrrolidinobenzyl)sulfide are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • 1,1′-Bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocenyl palladium chloride may be prepared according to Hayashi T. et al., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 106, 158 (1984). [0460]
  • Example 38
  • Method 1 [0461]
  • 0.65 cm[0462] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride is added to a solution of 2.94 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol in 250 cm3 of dichloromethane at 22° C., followed, in small portions over 15 minutes, by 2.42 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine; the orange-colored solution is stirred for 2 hours at room temperature. The reaction mixture is washed 3 times with 150 cm3 of distilled water and once with 150 cm3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution and then dried with magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5.5 cm, height 15 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (1/9 by volume) as eluents and collecting 70 cm3 fractions. Fractions 15 to 36 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.86 g of white foam are obtained, which foam is crystallized from isopropyl ether in order to obtain a solid melting at 190° C. A recrystallization from 145 cm3 of ethanol gives 1.08 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine melting at 206° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H,s, SCH3), 3.87 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.15 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (5H, m, 5CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • Method 2 [0463]
  • 0.80 g of ground sodium hydroxide is added to a solution of 2.2 g of 3-acetoxy-1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidine in 25 cm[0464] 3 of dioxane at room temperature. After 16 hours at room temperature, 50 cm3 of water and 100 cm3 of ethyl acetate are added. The mixture is separated after settling out, the organic phase rewashed with 100 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). A white foam is obtained which is crystallized from isopropyl ether in order to obtain 0.85 g of a solid melting at 190° C. Recrystallization from 20 cm3 of ethanol gives 0.70 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine melting at 205° C.
  • Example 39
  • 6.75 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and then 2.97 g of potassium carbonate are added to a solution of 6.8 g of bis(4-chlorophenyl)bromomethane in 300 cm[0465] 3 of acetonitrile. The reaction mixture is heated for 1 hour under reflux, cooled to room temperature, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 8.5 cm, height 22 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (25/75 by volume) as eluents and collecting 250 cm3 fractions. Fractions 11 to 48 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 5.3 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl) methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained. [1H NMR spectrum
  • (300 MHz, (CD[0466] 3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 2.00 (s, 3H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.25 (mt, 2H), 3.48 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.80 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 4.54 (s, 1H), 5.34 (s, 1H), 7.15 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H), 7.50 (broad t, J=9 Hz, 1H)].
  • Bis(4-chlorophenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933). [0467]
  • 3-[(3,5-Difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride may be obtained in the following manner: 160 cm[0468] 3 of a 6.2 N hydrochloric acid solution in dioxane are added to a solution of 37 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol in 160 cm3 of dioxane. After 16 hours at room temperature, the reaction mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is taken up in 320 cm3 of ethanol, heated for 1 hour under reflux and cooled in an ice-cold water bath. The solid which appears is filtered, washed with ethyl ether and dried at 40° C. under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 29.85 g of white crystals are obtained whose melting point is greater than 260° C.
  • 3-[(3,5-Difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: a solution of 14.0 cm[0469] 3 of vinyl chloroformate in 35 cm3 of dichloromethane is added at 5° C. to a solution of 60.18 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol in 1000 cm3 of dichloromethane. After 20 hours at room temperature, the reaction mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 11 cm, height 32 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (3/7 by volume) as eluents and collecting 1000 cm3 fractions. Fractions 8 to 18 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 37 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of white crystals melting at 195° C.
  • Example 40
  • 14 cm[0470] 3 of a 1.6 N n-butyllithium solution in hexane are added at −70° C. to a solution of 4.77 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone in 70 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran under an argon atmosphere. After 1 hour at −70° C., a solution of 6.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one in 30 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran is added and then, 1 hour later, a solution of 2.34 cm3 of acetyl chloride in 20 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran and the temperature of the reaction mixture is raised to 20° C. for 1 hour. 50 cm3 of water and 200 cm3 of ethyl acetate are added. The mixture is separated after settling out, the organic phase washed with 100 cm3 of water, 100 cm3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 14.4 g of 3-acetoxy-1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)methylsulfonylmethyl-(RS)]azetidine are obtained in the form of a yellow oil [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.79 (s, 3H), 3.04 (AB, J=9 Hz, 2H), 3.27 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.45 (s, 1H), 3.81 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 4.32 (s, 1H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.88 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.35 (mt, 10H)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared according to the following procedure: a solution of 8.1 cm[0471] 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide in 17.6 cm3 of dichloromethane is added to a solution of 5.0 cm3 of oxalyl chloride in 73 cm3 of dichloromethane cooled to −78° C. After 0.5 hour at −78° C., a solution of 16.0 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol dissolved in 50 cm3 of dichloromethane is poured in. After 5 hours at −78° C., 26.6 cm3 of triethylamine are added dropwise and the reaction mixture is allowed to return to room temperature. After 16 hours, the reaction mixture is washed with 4 times 200 cm3 of water and then with 200 cm3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 9.2 cm, height 21 cm) at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (40/60 by volume) as eluents and collecting 200 cm3 fractions. Fractions 15 to 25 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 8.9 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of pale yellow crystals melting at 111° C.
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared according to the procedure described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al., J. Heterocycl. Chem., (1994), 271 starting with 35.5 g of [bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]amine hydrochloride and 11.0 cm[0472] 3 of epichlorohydrin. 9.0 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ol are isolated.
  • [Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]amine hydrochloride may be prepared according to the method described by GRISAR M. et al., J. Med. Chem., 885 (1973). [0473]
  • Example 41
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 0.72 g of 1-[bis(4-methoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.0 cm, height 16.5 cm) at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 40 cm[0474] 3 fractions, 0.10 g of a white foam is obtained. After crystallization from a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane, 60 mg of 1-[bis(4-methoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a solid melting at 180° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.70 (6H, s, 2 OCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.15 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.58 (1H, s, NCH), 6.85 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.15 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (5H, m, 5CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-methoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 39 starting with 1.2 g of bis(4-methoxyphenyl)bromomethane and 1.2 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.8 cm, height 18 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (25/75 by volume) as eluent and collecting 50 cm[0475] 3 fractions, fractions 9 to 18 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.55 g of 1-[bis(4-methoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained.
  • Bis(4-methoxyphenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933). [0476]
  • Example 42
  • On carrying out the operation according to Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 0.47 g of 1-[bis(4-methylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3.2 cm, height 18.5 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (1/9 by volume) as eluent and collecting 35 cm[0477] 3 fractions, 0.30 g of a white solid is obtained. After crystallization from diisopropyl ether, 0.20 g of 1-[bis(4-methylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of white needles melting at 200° C.
  • 1-[Bis(4-methylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 39 starting with 0.7 g of bis(4-methylphenyl)bromomethane and 0.8 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.0 cm, height 19 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 40 cm[0478] 3 fractions, fractions 35 to 40 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.47 g of 1-[bis(4-methylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained.
  • Bis(4-methylphenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933). [0479]
  • Example 43
  • On carrying out the operation according to Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 1.42 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, a mixture of the two diastereoisomers, and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.0 cm, height 21 m), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 40 cm[0480] 3 fractions, 0.10 g of a white solid is obtained. After crystallization from diisopropyl ether, 50 mg of (RS)-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]-1-(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl]azetidine are obtained in the form of a white solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.23 (6H,s, 2 PhCH3), 3.00 (3H,s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.12 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.58 (1H, s, NCH), 7.08 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.15 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.25 (5H, m, 5CH arom.)]
  • The mixture of diastereoisomers 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 39 starting with 2.52 g (RS)-bromo(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methane and 2.85 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5.6 cm, height 19 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (25/75 by volume) as eluent and collecting 100 cm[0481] 3 fractions, fractions 11 to 18 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.16 g of the mixture of diastereoisomers 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained.
  • (RS)-bromo(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933). [0482]
  • Example 44
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 0.47 g of 1-[bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.2 cm, height 14 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 25 cm[0483] 3 fractions, 0.28 g of 1-[bis-(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.05 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.95 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.90 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.32 (5H, m, 5CH arom.), 7.60 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 39 starting with 1.59 g of bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)bromomethane and 1.2 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.8 cm, height 17 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (25/75 by volume) as eluent and collecting 50 cm[0484] 3 fractions, fractions 15 to 23 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.49 g of 1-[bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol is obtained.
  • Bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933), starting with 1.39 g of bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methanol, 3 cm[0485] 3 of 33% hydrobromic acid in acetic acid and 0.6 cm3 of acetyl bromide. 1.59 g of bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)bromomethane are obtained in the form of a brown oil.
  • Bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methanol is prepared according to PAVIA M. R. et al., J. Med. Chem., 4238 (1992). [0486]
  • Example 45
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 0.25 g of 1-[bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2.4 cm, height 14 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 20 cm[0487] 3 fractions, 0.12 g of 1-[bis-(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a white solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.05 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.95 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.90 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.32 (5H, m, 5CH arom.), 7.60 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 39 starting with 1.46 g of bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)bromomethane and 1.2 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.8 cm, height 17 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (30/70 by volume) as eluent and collecting 50 cm[0488] 3 fractions, fractions 9 to 14 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.25 g of 1-[bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained.
  • Bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933), starting with 2.5 g of bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)methanol, 6 cm[0489] 3 of 33% hydrobromic acid in acetic acid and 1.2 cm3 of acetyl bromide. 2.9 g of bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)bromomethane are obtained in the form of a brown oil.
  • Bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)methanol is prepared according to PAVIA M. R. et al., J. Med. Chem., 4238 (1992). [0490]
  • Example 46
  • On carrying out the operation according to Example 38 (Method 2), starting with 3.16 g of 3-acetoxy-1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)} azetidine and 0.96 g of ground sodium hydroxide, a yellow foam is obtained, after 16 hours at room temperature, which is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.8 cm, height 14 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (15/85 by volume) as eluent and collecting 40 cm[0491] 3 fractions. 1.49 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3,5-bis-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methylene} azetidine are thus obtained in the form of a white foam [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.05 (3H,s, SCH3), 3.90 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.30 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.40 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.50 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 8.10 (2H, s, 2CH arom.), 8.20 (1H, s, CH arom.)].
  • 3-Acetoxy-1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)} azetidine may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 40 starting with 2.0 g of [3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl]methylsulfone, 4.1 cm of a 1.6 N solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 2.0 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-one and 0.77 cm[0492] 3 of acetyl chloride in 20 cm3 of anhydrous diisopropyl ether, 3.56 g of 3-acetoxy-1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)}azetidine are obtained in the form of a white foam after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5.6 cm, height 16 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (1/9 by volume) as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions.
  • [3,5-Bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl]methylsulfone is prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 10 starting with 1.8 g of 3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl chloride and 1.22 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 1.86 g of [3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)benzyl]methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid. [0493]
  • Example 47
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 0.27 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2.4 cm, height 7.5 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (15/85 by volume) as eluent and collecting 20 cm[0494] 3 fractions, 0.10 g of (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine is obtained in the form of a white solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.02 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.82 (1H, dd, J=3 and 16 Hz, NCHH), 4.04 (1H, dd, J=3 and 16 Hz, NCHH), 4.10 (1H, dd, J=3 and 16 Hz, NCHH), 4.35 (1H, dd, J=3 and 16 Hz, NCHH), 5.12 (1H, s, NCH), 7.18 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.32 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, CH arom.), 7.38 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.45 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.48 (1H, dd, J=2 and 7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.58 (1H, d, J=2 Hz, CH arom.), 7.80 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.)].
  • The mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 39 starting with 0.56 g of (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methane and 0.50 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.0 cm, height 13 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (20/80 by volume) as eluent and collecting 40 cm[0495] 3 fractions, fractions 9 to 14 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.27 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluoro-phenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained.
  • (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933) starting with 4.05 g of (RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methanol, 10 cm[0496] 3 of 33% hydrobromic acid in acetic acid and 2.1 cm3 of acetyl bromide. 4.6 g of (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methane are obtained in the form of a greenish oil.
  • (RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methanol is prepared according to PAVIA M. R. et al., J. Med. Chem., 4238 (1992). [0497]
  • Example 48
  • 75.6 cm[0498] 3 of 5 N hydrochloric acid are added to a solution of 18.9 g of 1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 80 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran. After 3 hours at room temperature, the mixture is taken up in dichloromethane and distilled water and then adjusted to pH 14 by addition of 30% sodium hydroxide and separated after settling out. The organic phase is washed twice with 100 cm3 of water and then 100 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 16 g of (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a white foam [Spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.06 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.95 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.26 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.91 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.36 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, 1CH arom.), 7.40 and 7.52 (4H, 2d, J=7.5 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.70 and 7.88 (4H, 2d, J=7.5 Hz, 4CH arom.), 9.97 (1H, s, CH aldehydic)].
  • 1-{(4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be prepared according to the following method: 13.0 cm[0499] 3 of 1,8-diazabicyclo[5.4.0]undec-7-ene are added dropwise to a solution of 34.45 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 3-acetoxy-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidine in 400 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran under argon at 0° C., and after customary treatment, 16.6 g of 1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a white solid after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 10.2 cm, height 23 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 250 cm3 fractions.
  • The mixture of the two diastereoisomers 3-acetoxy-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidine may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 40, starting with 11.6 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone, 35.1 cm[0500] 3 of a 1.6 N solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 19.3 g of 1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-one and 8.8 cm3 of acetyl chloride in 500 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran, 37.8 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 3-acetoxy-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)-[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidine are obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • 1-{(4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-one may be prepared in the following manner: 46 cm[0501] 3 of triethylamine are added at room temperature to a solution of 28.32 g of 1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)} azetidin-3-ol in 200 cm3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, and then a solution of 34 g of sulfur trioxide-pyridine complex in 100 cm3 of dimethyl sulfoxide are added dropwise. After 0.25 hour at room temperature, the reaction mixture is poured over ice, extracted with ethyl acetate, washed with 3 times 400 cm3 of water and then with 400 cm3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 9.2 cm, height 21 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (20/80 by volume) as eluent and collecting 250 cm3 fractions. Fractions 9 to 18 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 20.4 g of 1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]-methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • 1-{(4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-ol may be prepared according to the procedure described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al., J. Heterocycl. Chem., 271 (1994) starting with 35.0 g of {(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl} amine, 8.3 g of epibromohydrin, 5.1 g of sodium hydrogen carbonate and 400 cm[0502] 3 of ethanol. 30.3 g of 1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-ol are isolated.
  • {(4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(RS)}amine hydrochloride may be prepared according to the method described by GRISAR M. et al., J. Med. Chem., 885 (1973) starting with 67.2 g of 4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)benzonitrile, 88.2 g of 1-bromo-4-chlorobenzene, 11 g of magnesium and 600 cm[0503] 3 of ethyl ether. 42.3 g of {(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]-methyl-(RS)}amine are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • Example 49
  • 0.020 g of sodium borohydride is added to a solution of 0.50 g of (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 15 cm[0504] 3 of methanol at 0° C. After 1 hour at 0° C., 40 cm3 of water are added and the product extracted with 100 cm3 of dichloromethane. The organic phase is washed twice with 40 cm3 of water and then 40 cm3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3.2 cm, height 14 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (30/70 by volume) and collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 20 to 25 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.29 g of (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]-methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a white foam [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.02 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.90 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.42 (2H, d, J=5 Hz, OCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 5.10 (1H, t, J=5 Hz, OH), between 7.10 and 7.50 (1H, m, 11CH arom.)].
  • Example 50
  • 0.75 g of (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine and then 0.68 g of sodium triacetoxyborohydride are added to a solution of 0.10 g of pyrrolidine in 20 cm[0505] 3 of 1,2-dichloroethane. After 20 hours at room temperature, 2 cm3 of 1 N sodium hydroxide are added, the product is extracted with 100 cm3 of dichloromethane, the organic phase is washed twice with 50 cm of water and then 50 cm3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.1 cm, height 13 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with acetate as eluent and collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 10 to 18 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.39 g of (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(pyrrolidylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a white foam [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 1.65 (4H, m, 2CH2), 2.40 (4H,m, 2NCH2), 3.02 (3H,s, SCH3), 3.50 (2H, s, NCH2Ph), 3.85 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.15 and 7.40 (9H, m, 9CH arom.), 7.48 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.)].
  • Example 51
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 50 starting with 0.93 cm[0506] 3 of a 2 M solution of dimethylamine in methanol, 30 cm3 of 1,2-dichloroethane, 0.75 g of (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine and then 0.9 g of sodium triacetoxyborohydride, there is obtained after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 17.5 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (30/70 by volume) as eluent and collecting 40 cm3 fractions, 0.46 g of (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-dimethylaminomethyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine in the form of a white solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.12 (6H, s, N(CH3)2), 3.02 (3H,s, SCH3), 3.32 (2H, s, NCH2Ph), 3.90 (2H,s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.18 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.22 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.35 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, CH arom.), 7.39 (4H, m, 4CH arom.), 7.48 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • Example 52
  • A solution of 0.5 g of (RS)-1-{(4-carboxyphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 10 cm[0507] 3 of dichloromethane at 0° C. is stirred with 0.5 cm3 of a solution (2 M) of dimethylamine in ethanol. 13 mg of hydroxybenzotriazole, 0.2 g of 1,3-dimethylaminopropyl-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride and 0.18 cm3 of diisopropylethylamine are then added. After 20 hours at room temperature, the reaction mixture is diluted with dichloromethane, washed twice with 80 cm3 of water and then 80 cm3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.1 cm, height 13 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane/acetonitrile/methanol (98/1/1 by volume) mixture as eluent and collecting 15 cm3 fractions. Fractions 13 to 15 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.16 g of a cream-colored solid is obtained which, after taking up in isopropyl ether and drying, gives 0.11 g of (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl) [4-N,N-dimethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in the form of a solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.85 (3H, broad s, NCH3), 2.95 (3H,broad s, NCH3), 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.90 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.15 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, CH arom.), 7.35 (4H, m, 4CH arom.), 7.50 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • (RS)-1-{(4-carboxyphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 1.0 cm[0508] 3 of Jones reagent is added to a solution of 0.50 g of (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 10 cm3 acetone at 0° C. After 5 hours, the reaction mixture is poured into distilled water, the product is extracted with 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate, the organic phase is washed twice with 50 cm3 of water and then 50 cm3 of a saturated sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from an ethyl acetate-cyclohexane mixture, filtered and dried. 0.50 g of (RS)-1-{(4-carboxyphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Example 53
  • The operation is carried out as in Example 52, starting with 1 g of (RS)-1-{(4-carboxyphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, 0.38 g of 1,3-dimethylaminopropyl-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride, 22 mg of hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate, 30 cm[0509] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.83 cm3 of a 2 M ethylamine solution in THF, chromatographing on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.1 cm, height 15 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (45/55 by volume) as eluent and collecting 30 cm3 fractions. Fractions 22 to 32 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.29 g of (RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethylcarbamoyl)-phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a white solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6 T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 1.07 (3H, t, J=6 Hz, CH3), 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.35 (2H, m, NCH2), 3.90 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.15 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, CH arom.), 7.35 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.48 (4H, m, 4CH arom.), 7.74 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 8.37 (1H, t, CONH)].
  • Example 54
  • The operation is carried out as in Example 52, starting with 1 g of (RS)-1-{(4-carboxyphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, 0.38 g of 1,3-dimethylaminopropyl-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride, 22 mg of hydroxybenzotriazole hydrate, 40 cm[0510] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.24 cm3 of a 7 N solution of ammonium hydroxide in methanol and chromatographing on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.1 cm, height 15 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (60/40 by volume) as eluent and collecting 35 cm3 fractions. Fractions 38 to 48 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.29 g of a solid is obtained which, after taking up in isopropyl ether and drying, gives 0.22 g of (RS)-1-[(4-carbamoylphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine in the form of a white solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3, 3.90 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.82 (1H, s, NCH), 7.17 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, CH arom.), 7.38 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.50 (5H, m, 4CH arom. and 2 CONH2), 7.80 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.90 (1H, s, 2 CONH2)].
  • Example 55
  • The operation is carried out according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 1.7 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.35 cm[0511] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.5 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine. The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 35 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (99.5/0.5 by volume) as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 7 to 10 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid is crystallized from 15 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.2 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine is obtained melting at 200° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.35 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (6H, m, 6CH arom.), 7.67 (1H, s, CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 39 starting with 4 g of bis(4-chlorophenyl)bromomethane and 3 g of 3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 40 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (99/1 by volume) as eluent and collecting 100 cm[0512] 3 fractions. Fractions 15 to 19 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.7 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • Bis(4-chlorophenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933). [0513]
  • 3-[(3,5-Dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 39 starting with 5.6 g of 3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol and 56 cm[0514] 3 of a 6.2 N solution of hydrochloric dioxane in 56 cm3 of dioxane, 5.1 g of 3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • 3-[(3,5-Dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 39 starting with 7.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol and 1.6 cm[0515] 3 of vinyl chloroformate in 75 cm3 of dichloromethane, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 40 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (30/70 by volume) as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 4 to 10 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 5.6 g of 3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • Example 56
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 0.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-dimethylaminophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.1 cm[0516] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.5 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (98/2 by volume) as eluent and collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 8 to 13 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 8 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-dimethylaminophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 176° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 2.90 (6H, s, N(CH3)2), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 6.70 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.20 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.48 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-dimethylaminophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 0.4 g of (3-dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfone, 0.4 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one and 1.2 cm[0517] 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 0.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-dimethylaminophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a solid melting at 185° C.
  • (3-Dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 1.4 g of (3-dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfide and 5.1 g of oxone[0518] R, 1.1 g of (3-dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 195° C.
  • (3-Dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 37 starting with 4 g of (3-iodobenzyl)methylsulfide, 1.4 g of dimethylamine in solution in 5 cm[0519] 3 of tetrahydrofuran, 2.9 g of sodium tert-butoxide, 0.56 g of 1,1-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocenylpalladium chloride and 1.3 g of 1,1′-bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene in 35 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran, 0.9 g of (3-dimethylaminobenzyl)methylsulfide is obtained in the form of an oil.
  • Example 57
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 1.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.3 cm[0520] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.4 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (98/2 by volume) as eluent and collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 11 to 13 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 15 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 146° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.45 (3H, s, PhSCH3), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.10 and 7.50 (14H, m, 14CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 1.1 g of methyl(3-methylsulfanylbenzyl)sulfone, 1.2 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a solid. [0521]
  • Methyl(3-methylsulfanylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 5 g of (3-iodobenzyl)methylsulfone and 1 g of tetrakistriphenylphosphinepalladium in 250 cm[0522] 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide is heated at a temperature close to 100° C., under a nitrogen stream, for 1 hour. 2.5 g of sodium methylthiolate are added and then the heating at 100° C. is maintained for 18 hours. The reaction medium is cooled to room temperature and taken up in 700 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 500 cm3 of water. The organic phase is decanted off, washed with 10 times 500 cm3 of water, 500 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, filtered on sintered glass and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (70/30 and then 60/40 and then 50/50 by volume) as eluent and collecting 30 cm3 fractions. Fractions 26 to 30 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.2 g of methyl(3-methylsulfanyl-benzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of an oil.
  • Example 58
  • 4 cm[0523] 3 of a 1 M solution of tetrabutylammonium fluoride in tetrahydrofuran are added to a solution, cooled to 5° C., of 1.1 g 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsiloxymethyl)phenyl] (methylsulfonyl)methylene} azetidine in 10 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran. The mixture is stirred for 3 hours at a temperature close to 20° C. and then taken up in 100 cm3 of ethyl acetate and twice 50 cm3 of water. The organic phase is decanted off, extracted, dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (95/5 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm 3fractions. Fractions 4 to 6 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-hydroxymethylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 152° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.50 (2H, d, J=5 Hz, OCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 5.25 (1H, t, J=5 Hz, OH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (8H, m. 8CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)phenyl]-(methylsulfonyl)methylene}azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 1.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsiloxymethyl)phenyl](methyl-sulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.3 cm[0524] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.4 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 60 cm3 fractions. Fractions 15 to 30 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsiloxymethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methylene}azetidine are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 148° C.
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)phenyl]-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2 g of [3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)benzyl]methylsulfone and 1.5 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one, 1.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 175° C. [0525]
  • [(3-(Tert-butyldimethylsilyloxy-methyl)benzyl]methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 13.4 g of (3-hydroxymethylbenzyl)methylsulfone, 11 g of imidazole and 12 g of tert-butyldimethylsilane chloride is stirred for 18 hours at a temperature close to 20° C. The solution is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5 cm, height 50 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm[0526] 3 fractions. Fractions 7 to 14 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 5.7 g of [3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)benzyl]methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 80° C.
  • (3-Hydroxymethylbenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 26 g of 3-(methylsulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid and 4.6 g of lithium aluminium hydride in 600 cm[0527] 3 of tetrahydrofuran is stirred for 18 hours at a temperature close to 20° C. The solution is cooled to 0° C. and then 15 cm3 of ethyl acetate, 5 cm3 of water, 5 cm3 of a 15% aqueous solution of sodium hydroxide and finally 30 cm3 of water are added successively. The mixture is filtered on celite, the filtrate taken up in 600 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is taken up in 500 cm3 of water and then 200 cm of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, decanted off, dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 10.4 g of (3-hydroxymethylbenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a gum.
  • 3-(Methylsulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 23.3 g of 3-chloromethylbenzoic acid and 23.3 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 26 g of 3-(methylsulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 210° C. [0528]
  • Example 59
  • 0.13 g of sodium methylthiolate is added, while the temperature is maintained below 30° C., to a solution of 0.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromomethyl-phenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 8 cm[0529] 3 of dimethylformamide. The mixture is stirred for 18 hours at a temperature close to 20° C. and then taken up in 30 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 50 cm3 of water. The organic phase is decanted off, extracted and washed with 3 times 50 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 28 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of cyclohexane and ethyl acetate (90/10 by volume) as eluent and collecting 50 cm3 fractions. Fractions 8 to 14 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(methylsulfanylmethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methylene])} azetidine is obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 150° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, δ in ppm (300 MHz): 1.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.75 (2H, s, SCH2), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.30 (8H, d, J=7 Hz, 8CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromomethylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 0.23 cm[0530] 3 of phosphorus tribromide and then a drop of pyridine are added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to a mixture of 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-hydroxymethylphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 10 cm3 of dichloromethane. The stirring is maintained for 18 hours at the same temperature. The reaction medium is taken up in 20 cm3 of water and 10 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution. The organic phase is decanted off, extracted, dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromomethylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a foam used in the crude state in subsequent syntheses.
  • Example 60
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 6.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(quinol-8-yl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.7 cm[0531] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 5.2 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 6.5 cm, height 35 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume) as eluent and collecting 40 cm3 fractions. Fractions 7 to 15 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 100 cm3 of ethyl ether. 4.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(quinol-8-yl)methylene]azetidine are obtained melting at 212° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.15 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.55 (2H, broad s, NCH2), 4.30 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.70 (1H, s, NCH), 7.18 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.25 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.43 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.), 7.62 (2H, m, 2CH quinoline), 7.75 (1H, dd, J=2 and 7 Hz, CH quinoline), 8.05 (1H, dd, J=2 and 7 Hz, CH quinoline), 8.43 (1H, dd, J=2 and 8 Hz, CH quinoline), 9.00 (1H, dd, J=2 and 5 Hz, CH quinoline)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(quinol-8-yl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 5.5 g of methyl(quinol-8-ylmethyl)sulfone, 5.9 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one and 18.8 cm[0532] 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 6.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(quinol-8-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a beige solid.
  • Methyl(quinol-8-ylmethyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 4.5 g of 8-chloromethylquinoline and 4.4 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 5.7 g of methyl(quinol-8-ylmethyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a beige solid. [0533]
  • 8-Chloromethyl quinoline may be prepared in the following manner: 6.7 g of N-chlorosuccinimide and then 250 mg of benzoyl peroxide are added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to a mixture of 7.1 g of 8-methylquinoline in 250 cm[0534] 3 of carbon tetrachloride. The reaction medium is heated at the reflux temperature of the solvent for 36 hours and then cooled to 20° C. The mixture is filtered on sintered glass and the filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 5.5 cm, height 32 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 40 cm3 fractions. Fractions 21 to 40 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 4.5 g of 8-chloromethyl-quinoline are obtained in the form of a brown oil which is used in the crude state in subsequent syntheses.
  • Example 61
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 6.2 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 1.4 cm[0535] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 6.1 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 60 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 4 to 7 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 25 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.7 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a solid melting at 178° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 7.30 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.40 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.60 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.70 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.85 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 5.5 g of (3-cyanophenyl)-methylsulfone, 6.1 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one and 13.8 cm[0536] 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 6.3 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • Example-62
  • A mixture of 4.5 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 50 cm[0537] 3 of acetic acid and 50 cm3 of concentrated hydrochloric acid (d=1.18) is heated at 50° C. for 20 hours. The reaction medium is cooled to room temperature and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The oil obtained is taken up in 100 cm3 of ethanol and then the solution is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is precipitated in 60 cm3 of ethyl ether. The solid obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 25 cm, height 40 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99.5/0.5 by volume) as eluent and collecting 30 cm3 fractions. Fractions 35 to 46 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 15 cm3 of ethyl ether. 0.2 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carbamoylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a solid melting at 192° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.35 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (5H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom. and 2 CONH2), 7.50 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 7.85 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • Example 63
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 0.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)} azetidin-3-ol, 0.2 cm[0538] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.7 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (98/2 by volume) as eluent, collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 4 to 8 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is recrystallized from 10 cm3 of ethyl acetate. 0.5 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methylene}-azetidine is obtained in the form of a solid melting at 161° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 1.30 (9H, s, (CH3)3), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.15 (3H, s, NCH3), 3.75 (2H, s, SCH2), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.15 and 7.50 (14H, m, 14CH arom.)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-{[3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 1.6 g of [3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)benzyl]methylsulfone, 1.3 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one and 3.8 cm[0539] 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 0.8 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • [3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)benzyl]methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: 2.5 g of di-tert-butyl dicarbonate in 40 cm[0540] 3 of dioxane are added to a solution, cooled to 0° C. of methyl(3-methylaminobenzyl)sulfone in 30 cm3 of dioxane. The stirring is maintained for 18 hours at room temperature. The reaction medium is taken up in 75 cm3 of dichloromethane; the organic phase is washed with 75 cm3 of water and then with 75 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution. The organic phase is decanted off, extracted, dried over anhydrous sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 35 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a cyclohexane and ethyl acetate mixture (50/50 by volume) as eluent, collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 5 to 10 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.8 g of [3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)benzyl]methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a colorless oil.
  • Methyl(3-methylaminobenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 9.7 cm[0541] 3 of formic acid (d=1.22) and 19.6 cm3 of acetic anhydride (d=1.08) is heated for 3 hours at 50° C. and then the solution is allowed to return to room temperature. 40 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran are added and the mixture is cooled to −20° C. 14.8 g of (3-aminobenzyl)methylsulfone and 200 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran are then added. The stirring is maintained for 2 hours at −20° C. and then 48 hours at room temperature. The mixture is filtered on sintered glass, the precipitate is washed with 3 times 50 cm3 of diisopropyl ether and then dried. The filtrate is concentrated to half its volume (2.7 kPa), the precipitate obtained is filtered on sintered glass and washed with 3 times 30 cm3 of diisopropyl ether and then dried. The two precipitates are combined and dissolved in 375 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran. The solution is cooled to 0° C.; 100 cm3 of a 2 M solution of borane dimethyl sulfide in tetrahydrofuran added and then heated under reflux for 3 hours. The mixture is cooled to 5° C. and then 60 cm3 of methanol are added over 20 minutes. The stirring is maintained for 1 hour at room temperature. A stream of hydrogen chloride is bubbled in the solution for 5 minutes. The reaction medium is then heated under reflux for 1 hour, cooled to room temperature and taken up in 300 cm3 of water. The solution is alkalinized with 3N sodium hydroxide and then with a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic phase is extracted with twice 250 cm3 of ethyl acetate, washed with 300 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution and twice 300 cm3. It is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The oil obtained is taken up in 100 cm3 of 4 N hydrochloric acid and then with 100 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The aqueous phase is alkalinized with 120 cm3 of 3 N sodium hydroxide, and then with an aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic phase is extracted with twice 75 cm3 of ethyl acetate, dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 9 g of methyl(3-methylaminobenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a pink solid.
  • (3-Aminobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: a mixture of 23.7 g of methyl(3-nitrobenzyl)sulfone, 65 cm[0542] 3 of hydrochloric acid (d=1.18) and 150 cm3 of methanol is heated under reflux for 15 minutes. 18.5 g of iron are added over 10 minutes and the reflux is maintained for 4 hours and then 18 hours at room temperature. The reaction medium is alkalinized with an aqueous solution of ammonium hydroxide and then with an aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic phase is extracted with 3 times 250 cm3 of ethyl acetate, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered on sintered glass and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 14.9 g of (3-aminobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of a beige solid which is used in the crude state in subsequent syntheses.
  • Example 64
  • A mixture of 0.3 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(N-tert-butyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methylene}azetidine, 4 cm[0543] 3 of a 4.7 N solution of hydrochloric dioxane and 4 cm3 of dioxane is stirred for 18 hours at room temperature. The reaction medium is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is taken up in 100 cm3 of water and 20 cm3 of diethyl ether. The aqueous phase is alkalinized with 30 cm3 of an aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic phase is extracted with twice 40 cm3 of ethyl acetate, washed with twice 30 cm3 of water, decanted off, dried over anhydrous magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is crystallized from 20 cm3 of diethyl ether. 0.16 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylaminophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a solid melting at 161° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 2.65 (3H, d, J=5 Hz, NCH3), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 5.80 (1H, q, J=5 Hz, NH), 6.60 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.15 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.22 (2H, t, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.30 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.48 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.)].
  • Example 65
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 11.3 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 2.6 cm[0544] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 10.9 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 5 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine are obtained after recrystallization from 20 cm3 of diethyl ether, melting at 181° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.77 (3H, s, OCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 6.95 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.35 (5H, m, 5CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 6.6 g of (3-methoxybenzyl)methylsulfone, 10 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one and 23 cm[0545] 3 of a 1.6 N solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 11.4 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 130° C.
  • Example 66
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 32 starting with 4.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, 32 cm[0546] 3 of a 1 M solution of boron tribromide in dichloromethane, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (98/2 by volume) as eluent and collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 16 to 17 are concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.1 g 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-hydroxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after recrystallization from 5 cm3 of diethyl ether, in the form of a solid melting at 114° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 2.92 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 6.80 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.20 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.37 (4H, t, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.47 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.)].
  • Example 67
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 0.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pyrrolidinylphenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.1 cm[0547] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.5 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture as eluent (98.5/1.5 by volume) and collecting 10 cm3 fractions. Fraction 4 is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.5 g 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pyrrolidinylphenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after recrystallization from 5 cm3 of diethyl ether, in the form of a solid melting at 133° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (400 MHz): 2.00 (4H, m, 2 CH2), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.20 (4H, m, 2 NCH2), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 6.50 (1H, s, CH arom.), 6.60 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 6.65 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom), 7.20 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.40 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.), 7.50 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pyrrolidinylphenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 0.5 g of methyl(3-pyrrolidinylbenzyl)sulfone, 0.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-one and 1.4 cm[0548] 3 of a 1.6 N solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 0.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-pyrrolidinylphenyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a cream-colored solid.
  • Example 68
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 58 starting with 5.1 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methylene}azetidine and 17 cm[0549] 3 of a 1 M solution of tetrabutylammonium fluoride in tetrahydrofuran, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (97/3 by volume) as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 10 to 14 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The yellow solid obtained is taken up in 2 cm3 of dichloromethane and 10 cm3 of ethyl acetate and then filtered on sintered glass and washed with 2 cm3 of ethyl acetate. 1.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-hydroxymethylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 214° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (400 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.50 (2H, d, J=5 Hz, OCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 5.25 (1H, t, J=5 Hz, OH), 7.30 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), between 7.35 and 7.45 (7H, m, 7CH arom.), 7.50 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methylene} azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 10.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-ol, 2 cm[0550] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 8.5 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 40 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 29 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 5.2 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)phenyl] (methyl sulfonyl)methylene} azetidine are obtained in the form of a gum.
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)} azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 5.8 g of [3-(tert-butylsilyloxymethyl)-benzyl]methylsulfone and 5.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one, 10.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(tert-butyldimethylsilyloxymethyl)-phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a gum. [0551]
  • Example 69
  • A mixture of 0.45 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene}azetidine, 0.07 cm[0552] 3 of 1-aminopiperidine in 4 cm of dimethylformamide is stirred for 18 hours at room temperature. The mixture is taken up in 30 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is washed with 3 times 50 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.2 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(N-piperidylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methylene}—azetidine is obtained melting at 175° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (400 MHz): 1.40 (2H, m, CH2), 1.60 (4H, m, 2CH2), 2.85 (4H, m, 2NCH2), 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.45 and 7.60 (10H, m, 10CH arom.), 7.75 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 9.45 (1H, s, NH)].
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene} azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 29 starting with 2.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine hydrochloride, 0.9 g of pentafluorophenol, 0.9 g of 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride in 25 cm[0553] 3 of dimethylformamide, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 30 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (99/1 by volume) as eluent and collecting 30 cm3 fractions. Fractions 7 to 12 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.9 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene}azetidine is obtained in the form of a foam.
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 2 cm[0554] 3 of Jones reagent are added to a mixture of 0.5 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-hydroxymethylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine in 9 cm3 of acetone, cooled to 5° C. This stirring is maintained for 2 hours at this temperature and then 50 cm3 of a mixture of water and ice and 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate are added. The organic phase is decanted off, washed with 50 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 25 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol as eluent and collecting 60 cm3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 14 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The solid obtained is crystallized from 10 cm3 of ethyl ether. 32 mg of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine are obtained in the form of a solid melting at 205° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (400 MHz): 2.90 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.33 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.39 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.42 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.49 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.57 (1H, d, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.90 (2H, s, CH arom. and NH+)].
  • Example 70
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure for Example 4 starting with 0.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylphenyl)methyl(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.24 g of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.7 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 18 cm) at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 50 cm[0555] 3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 17 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is again purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 20 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane as eluent and collecting 30 cm3 fractions. Fractions 15 to 28 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.25 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylphenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained melting at 70° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6+CD3CO2D, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.35 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.), 7.60 (2H, m, 2CH arom), 7.75 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylphenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 2 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylbenzyl)sulfone, 2.3 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one and 5.5 cm[0556] 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 0.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylphenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylbenzyl)sulfone may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 5 g of 3-trifluoromethylsulfanylbenzyl chloride and 3.2 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 5.2 g of methyl(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylbenzyl)sulfone are obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 125° C. [0557]
  • Example 71
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 0.72 g of 1-[bis(4-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.18 cm[0558] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.66 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.42 g of 1-[bis(4-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 2.5 cm, height 15 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (15/85 by volume) as eluent and collecting 25 cm3 fractions, in the form of a white foam [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.05 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.90 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.15 (6H, m, 6CH arom.), 7.35 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, CH arom.), 7.50 (4H, dd, J=6 and 8 Hz, 4CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: the operation is carried out as in Example 39 starting with 2.25 g of bis(4-fluorophenyl)bromomethane, 1.1 g of potassium carbonate and 2.5 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride. After chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.4 cm, height 25 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.9 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm[0559] 3 fractions, fractions 23 to 39 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.72 g of 1-[bis(4-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Bis(4-fluorophenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933) starting with 4 g of 4,4′-difluorobenzydrol, 2.70 cm[0560] 3 of acetal bromide and 14 cm3 of a 33% hydrobromic acid solution in acetic acid.
  • Example 72
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 1.22 g of 1-[bis(2-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.29 cm[0561] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.1 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.177 g of 1-[bis(2-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 23 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (15/85 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm3 fractions, in the form of a white foam [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.05 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.95 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, s, NCH2), 5.35 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (6H, m, 6CH arom.), 7.35 (3H, m, 3CH arom.), 7.55 (2H, m, 2CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(2-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: the operation is carried out as in Example 39 starting with 2 g of bis(2-fluorophenyl)bromomethane, 1.0 g of potassium carbonate and 2.22 g of 3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride. After chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 17 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm[0562] 3 fractions, fractions 6 to 10 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.22 g of 1-[bis(2-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a whitish solid.
  • Bis(2-fluorophenyl)bromomethane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933), starting with 1.80 g of 2,2′-difluorobenzydrol, 1.22 cm[0563] 3 of acetyl bromide and 6.5 cm3 of a 33% solution of hydrobromic acid in acetic acid.
  • 2,2′-difluorobenzydrol may be prepared according to the following method: 32 cm[0564] 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane are poured dropwise into a solution, cooled to −70° C. under argon, of 8.8 g of 2-bromofluorobenzene in 100 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran. After stirring for 10 minutes at −70° C., 2.1 cm3 of ethyl formate are added slowly and then the mixture is stirred at −70° C. for 30 minutes. The reaction medium is then brought to 0° C. and then supplemented with 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 100 cm3 of saturated ammonium chloride solution. After stirring, the organic phase is separated, dried over magnesium sulfate, concentrated to dryness at 55° C., under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). 3.63 g of 2,2′-difluorobenzydrol are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • Example 73
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 1.15 g of 1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.264 cm[0565] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride, and 0.98 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.55 g of 1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 2.8 cm, height 25 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (15/85 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm3 fractions, in the form of a white solid melting at 178° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 3.05 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.95 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.25 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.10 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 7.20 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), between 7.30 and 7.50 (7H, m, 7CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 1 starting with 1.2 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 1.5 g of 1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one, 1.95 g of 1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained, after purification on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 3.2 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (2/8 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm[0566] 3 fractions, in the form of a white solid melting at 170° C. (decomposition).
  • 1-[Bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared by carrying out the operation in a manner identical to the procedure described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al., J. Heterocycl. Chem., 271 (1994), starting with 4.9 g of [bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]amine and 1.78 cm[0567] 3 of epichlorohydrin.
  • [Bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]amine may be prepared in the following manner: a solution of 5.17 g of 3,3′-difluorobenzophenone oxime in 30 cm[0568] 3 of tetrahydrofuran is poured, under an argon atmosphere over 30 minutes, into a suspension of 1.27 g of lithium aluminum hydride in 80 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran. After stirring for 5 hours under reflux, 1.3 cm3 of water, 1.3 cm3 of 4 N sodium hydroxide, 2.6 cm3 of water and then 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate are added successively. After drying over magnesium sulfate and concentrating to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa), 4.9 g of [bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]amine are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • 3-3′-Difluorobenzophenone oxime may be prepared according to the following procedure: a solution of 1.6 g of hydroxylamine hydrochloride in 8 cm[0569] 3 of water is poured dropwise into a solution of 5.0 g of 3,3′-difluorobenzophenone in 10 cm3 of ethanol, and then 1.2 g of sodium hydroxide pellets are added in small fractions. The reaction mixture, heated under reflux for 10 minutes, is cooled to 20° C. and then acidified with 7.5 cm3 of 4 N hydrochloric acid. Once triturated, the oily precipitate obtained becomes a white solid which is filtered, washed with water and then dried at 35° C. under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 5.17g of 3,3′-difluorobenzophenone oxime are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Example 74
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 1, starting with 1.30 g of a mixture of two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.35 cm[0570] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.22 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.7 g of (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)-methylene]azetidine is obtained, after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 2.4 cm, height 25 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (1/1 by volume) as eluent and collecting 30 cm3 fractions, in the form of a pinkish solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.95 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.35 (2H, m, NCH2), 5.25 (1H, s, NCH), 7.45 (9H, m, 9CH arom.), 7.65 (1H, d, J=2 Hz, CH thiazole), 7.70 (1H, d, J=2 Hz, CH thiazole)].
  • The mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thiazol-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 39 starting with 4.47 g of (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)-methane and 4.31 g of 3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 5.6 cm, height 40 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (25/75 by volume) up to fraction 35 and then with pure ethyl acetate as eluent and collecting 60 cm[0571] 3 fractions, fractions 38 to 40 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.3 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a whitish solid.
  • (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933), starting with 3.5 g of (RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(2-thiazolyl)methanol, 3.81 g of acetyl bromide and 12.0 cm[0572] 3 of a 33% solution of hydrobromic acid in acetic acid.
  • (RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methanol may be prepared according to the procedure described by G. EVAN BOSWELL et al., J. Heterocyclic Chem., 32, 1801 (1995), starting with 4.22 g of 4-chlorobenzaldehyde and 4.92 g of 2-bromothiazole. [0573]
  • Example 75
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 1, starting with 0.52 g of a mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.14 cm[0574] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.49 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.32 g of (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 2.4 cm, height 20 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (20/80 by volume) as eluent and collecting 30 cm3 fractions, in the form of a white solid melting at 176° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.98 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.90 (2H, m, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 5.03 (1H, s, NCH), 6.85 (1H, dd, J=3 and 5 Hz, CH thiophene), 7.08 (3H, m, 2CH arom. and 1CH thiophene), 7.22 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, CH arom.),7.32 (3H, m, 2CH arom. and 1CH thiophene), 7.40 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.)].
  • The mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 1 starting with 1.60 cm[0575] 3 of 1.6 N n-butyllithium in solution in hexane, 0.83 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 1.06 g of 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-one, 0.55 g of the mixture of diastereoisomers 1-[4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained, after purification on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 2.8 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (25/75 by volume) as eluent and collecting 40 cm3 fractions, in the form of an off-white solid.
  • 1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-one may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 3.04 cm[0576] 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide are poured over 10 minutes into a solution, cooled to −70° C., of 1.83 cm3 of oxalyl chloride in 20 cm3 of dichloromethane under argon. After stirring for 30 minutes at −60° C., a solution of 5.2 g of 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol in 80 cm3 of dichloromethane is poured in over 20 minutes, the mixture is stirred for 3 hours at a temperature of between −60° and −70° C. and then 9.12 cm3 of triethylamine are added. The mixture is then allowed to return to room temperature and then diluted with water. The organic phase is separated, dried over magnesium sulfate and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure. The residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 36 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (1/9 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm3 fractions. 3.3 g of 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-zetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of a yellow oil which crystallizes at room temperature.
  • 1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared in the following manner: 4.12 g of sodium bicarbonate are added to a solution of 11.0 g of [(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-amine in 80 cm[0577] 3 of ethanol. The mixture is heated at 65° C. and supplemented with 4.03 cm3 of epibromohydrin. After stirring for 20 hours at 65° C., the cooled mixture is filtered and the filtrate concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). The residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 3.6 cm, height 32 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (25/75 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm3 fractions. 6.3 g of 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a pale yellow oil.
  • [(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-amine may be prepared in the following manner: a solution of 10.92 g of 2-thiophenecarbonitrile in 80 cm[0578] 3 of ethyl ether is poured slowly into a suspension, cooled to 10° C., of 4-chlorophenylmagnesium bromide (prepared from 19.15 g of 4-bromochlorobenzene and 2.43 g of magnesium) in 120 cm3 of anhydrous ethyl ether. After refluxing for one hour, the mixture is cooled to 10° C., supplemented slowly with 40 cm3 of methanol and then filtered on supercel. 4.54 g of sodium borohydride are added under argon and in small fractions over 15 minutes and then the reaction medium is stirred for 20 hours at 20° C. The mixture obtained is diluted with ethyl acetate and then washed with water. The organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate, concentrated to dryness at 50° C. under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 5 cm, height 42 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (4/6 by volume) as eluent and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 6 to 12, concentrated to dryness, correspond to 13 g of imine in the form of a yellow oil which is taken up in 100 cm3 of methanol. The solution obtained is supplemented with 2.4 g of sodium borohydride and stirred for one hour at 5° C. The mixture obtained is diluted with ethyl acetate and then washed with water. The organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate, concentrated to dryness at 50° C. under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). The residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 3.2 cm, height 40 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (4/6 by volume) as eluent and collecting 60 cm3 fractions. 11.0 g of [(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]amine are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • Example 76
  • On carrying out the operation as described in Example 75, starting with 1.66 g of the mixture of the two chiral diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl-(R*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]-azetidin-3-ol and 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(R*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(S*)]azetidin-3-ol, 50 cm[0579] 3 of dichloromethane, 0.45 cm3 of methanesulfonyl chloride, and 1.64 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.6 g of (+)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of white crystals melting at 136° C., [a]20 D=+3.2°(c=0.5% in dichloromethane).
  • The mixture of the two chiral diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl-(R*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]-azetidin-3-ol and 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(R*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(S*)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 1.06 g of (+)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)-methyl]azetidin-3-one, 0.82 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone, 2.5 cm[0580] 3 of 1.6 N solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, and 25 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran. 1.7 g of the mixture of the two chiral diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(R*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]azetidin-3-ol and 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(R*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(S*)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained, after purification by chromatography, in the form of a white solid.
  • (+)-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 12.4 g of (+)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol, 220 cm[0581] 3 of dichloromethane, 7.1 cm3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, 4.4 cm3 of oxalyl chloride and 21.5 cm3 of triethylamine. 9.2 g of (+)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of a pale yellow oil crystallizing at 20° C.
  • (+)-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ol may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 16.1 g of (+)-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine, 130 cm[0582] 3 of ethanol, 5.9 cm3 of epibromohydrin and 6.05 g of sodium bicarbonate. 11.5 g of (+)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ol are obtained, after purification by chromatography, in the form of a cream-colored oil.
  • (+)-4-[(Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine may be prepared in the following manner: 73 g of D-(−)-tartaric acid are added to a solution of 109 g of [(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]amine in 500 cm[0583] 3 of methanol. The mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The foam obtained is taken up in 2.05 liters of an ethanol-water 90/10 by volume mixture. After stirring slowly for 20 hours at 20° C., the crystalline suspension obtained is filtered, the crystals washed with a minimum amount of the same mixture of solvents, and then dried. Another recrystallization is carried out under the same conditions with 1.5 liters of the same mixture of solvents. 44.9 g of crystals of the acid tartrate of the amine are obtained. [a]20 D=+10.3°(c=0.5% in dimethylformamide). This compound is recrystallized from 600 cm3 of an ethanol-water 80/20 by volume mixture (the crystals are filtered and washed with twice 30 cm3 of the same mixture of solvents and then drained) and then recrystallized under the same conditions with 400 cm3 of an ethanol-water 78/22 mixture. 28.2 g of acid D-(−)-tartrate of (+)-[(4-chlorophenyl)thien-2-yl)methyl]amine are obtained in the form of white crystals [a]20 D=+10.8°(c=0.5% in dimethylformamide).
  • This salt is taken up in 400 cm[0584] 3 of a 1 N aqueous solution of sodium hydroxide and with 100 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is separated, washed with 100 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 16.1 g of (+)-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine are obtained in the form of an oil which crystallizes at 20° C. [a]20 D=+32.7°(c=0.5% in dichloromethane).
  • Example 77
  • On carrying out the operation as described in Example 75, starting with 1.30 g of the mixture of the two chiral diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl-(S*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]-azetidin-3-ol and 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(S*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(S*)]azetidin-3-ol, 40 cm[0585] 3 of dichloromethane, 0.35 cm3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 1.28 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.97 g of (−)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]zetidine is obtained in the form of white crystals melting at 135° C., [a]20 D=−3.4° (c=0.5% in dichloromethane).
  • The mixture of the two chiral diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl-(S*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]-azetidin-3-ol and 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(S*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(S*)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 1.06 g of (−)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)-methyl]azetidin-3-one, 0.82 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone, 2.5 cm[0586] 3 of 1.6 N solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, and 25 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran. 1.3 g of the mixture of the two chiral diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(S*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]azetidin-3-ol and 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(S*)]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(S*)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained after purification by chromatography in the form of a white solid.
  • (−)-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 11.4 g of (−)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol, 200 cm[0587] 3 of dichloromethane, 4.0 cm3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, 4.0 cm3 of oxalyl chloride and 19.5 cm3 of triethylamine. 8.3 g of (−)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of a pale yellow oil crystallizing at 20° C.
  • (−)-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared as described in Example 75, starting with 15.4 g of (−)-[(4-chlorophenyl)-(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine, 120 cm[0588] 3 of ethanol, 5.8 cm3 of epibromohydrin and 5.8 g of sodium bicarbonate. 10.7 g of (−)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ol are obtained, after purification by chromatography, in the form of a cream-colored oil.
  • (−)-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine may be prepared in the following manner: 29 g of L-(+)-tartaric acid are added to a solution of 43 g of [(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]amine in 200 cm[0589] 3 of methanol. The mixture obtained crystallizes in 2 hours at room temperature. The crystals are filtered, washed with twice 10 cm3 of methanol. Recrystallization is carried out with 500 cm3 of an ethanol-water 80/20 by volume mixture, the crystals are filtered, washed with twice 30 cm3 of the same mixture of solvents and then dried under vacuum at 45° C. A final recrystallization is carried out with 350 cm3 of an ethanol-water 78/22 by volume mixture, allowing the mixture to be stirred for 20 hours at 20° C. The crystals obtained are drained, dried under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 26 g of acid L-(+)-tartrate of (−)-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine are obtained. [a]20 D=−10.7°(c=0.5% in dimethylformamide).
  • This salt is taken up in 400 cm[0590] 3 of a 1 N aqueous sodium hydroxide solution and with 100 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is separated, washed with 100 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 15.4 g of (−)-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine are obtained in the form of an oil which crystallizes at 20° C. [a]20 D=−31.7° (c=0.5% in dichloromethane).
  • Example 78
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 3.4 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(ethylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.72 cm[0591] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 3.8 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 1.9 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(ethylsulfonyl)(phenyl)-methylene]azetidine are obtained, after recrystallization from 40 cm3 of acetonitrile, in the form of crystals melting at 210° C. [[NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 1.15 (3H, t, J=6 Hz, CH3), 2.92 (2H, q, J=6 Hz, CH2), 3.83 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), between 7.20 and 7.50 (15H, m, 3 phenyls)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-[(ethylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained by carrying out the operation according to the procedure described in Example 1 starting with 2.4 g of benzylethylsulfone, 2.2 cm[0592] 3 of diisopropylamine, 10 cm3 of 1.6 N n-butyllithium in solution in hexane, 65 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran and 3.1 g of 1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-one. 3.6 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(ethylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained, after recrystallization from 30 cm3 of acetonitrile, in the form of white crystals melting at 222° C.
  • Benzylethylsulfone may be prepared by carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 2 starting with 6.3 g of benzylethylsulfide, 50 cm[0593] 3 of acetic acid, 50 cm3 of water, 25 cm3 of 36 N sulfuric acid and 24.8 g of oxoneR. 3.2 g of benzylethylsulfone are obtained, by recrystallization from 20 cm of ethyl ether, in the form of a solid melting at 86° C.
  • Benzylethylsulfide may be prepared in the following manner: 1.2 g of sodium hydride are added in small portions to a solution of 5 g of benzylmercaptan in 50 cm[0594] 3 of dimethylformamide under argon, and then 3.36 cm3 of ethyl iodide are poured in, while the temperature is maintained below 45° C. The mixture is stirred for 2 hours and then taken up in 200 cm3 of ethyl ether. The organic phase is washed with 200 cm3 of water and then with 3 times 100 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 6.3 g of benzylethylsulfide are obtained in the form of a pale yellow liquid.
  • Example 79
  • 0.083 g of 1-amino-4-methylpiperazine is added to a solution of 0.45 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene]azetidine in 5 cm[0595] 3 of dimethylformamide. The mixture is stirred for 20 hours at room temperature and then 40 cm3 of ethyl acetate are added. The organic phase is washed with 4 times 20 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is triturated with 10 cm3 of ethyl ether, filtered and then dried. 0.2 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{(methylsulfonyl)[(N-4-methylpiperazinylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methylene}azetidine is obtained in the form of a yellow solid melting at 162° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.20 (3H, s, NCH3), 2.40 (4H, m, 2 NCH2), 2.90 (4H, m, 2 NCH2), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.40 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.50 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.55 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 7.80 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 9.50 (1H, s, CONH)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 0.94 g of N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-N′-ethylcarbodiimide hydrochloride and 0.89 g of pentafluorophenol are added to a solution of 2.9 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine in 25 cm[0596] 3 of dimethylformamide. The mixture is stirred for 20 hours at room temperature and then taken up in 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is washed with 100 cm3 of water, 200 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution and then with twice 50 cm3 of distilled water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). The residue is chromatographed on a silica column (particle size 0.04-0.006 mm, diameter 2 cm), eluting with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (99/1 by volume). 0.92 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: a 36% solution of hydrochloric acid at a temperature of 50° C. is added to a solution of 3.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 5 cm[0597] 3 of acetic acid. The heating is continued for 48 hours and then the mixture is evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). The residue is taken up in 30 cm3 of ethanol and again evaporated to dryness. The residue is triturated in 35 cm3 of ethyl ether. 3.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carboxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene)]azetidine are obtained in the form of a beige solid.
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine may be prepared according to the procedure of Example 4, starting with 11 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 150 cm[0598] 3 of dichloromethane, 2.54 cm3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 10.7 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, at room temperature for 3 hours. The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.5 cm) and eluted with dichloromethane and then with a mixture of dichloromethane and ethanol (99.6/0.4 by volume). The fractions are evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). 3.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared in the following manner: a solution of 5 g of 3-cyanobenzyl methyl sulfone in 500 cm of tetrahydrofuran is added over 15 minutes to a solution of 17.6 cm[0599] 3 of 1.6 M n-butyllithium in hexane, in 30 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran under argon, and cooled to −70° C. The mixture is stirred for 1 hour 30 minutes. Next, a solution of 7.8 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-one in 80 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran is poured in over 10 minutes. After stirring for 1 hour 30 minutes, 60 cm3 of a saturated aqueous ammonium chloride solution are poured in and then the mixture is allowed to return to room temperature. The mixture is taken up in 300 cm3 of ethyl acetate, the organic phase washed with 200 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate and evaporated under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). 11 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • (3-Cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone may be prepared in the following manner: starting with a solution of 20.2 g of 3-chloromethylbenzonitrile in 200 cm[0600] 3 of ethanol, 17.4 g of 85% sodium methanesulfinate are added. The mixture is stirred for 20 hours under reflux and then taken up in 500 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 500 cm3 of water. The insoluble matter is filtered off, the organic phase in the filtrate is dried over magnesium sulfate and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). The solid obtained is triturated with 100 cm3 of ethyl ether. After filtration and drying of the solid, 21 g of (3-cyanobenzyl)methylsulfone are obtained in the form of white crystals melting at 165° C.
  • 3-Chloromethylbenzonitrile may be prepared in the following manner: 32 g of 3-chloromethylbenzoamide in 200 cm[0601] 3 of phosphorus oxychloride are heated at 95° C. for 3 hours, and then 1 liter of ice is loaded, the mixture stirred for 1 hour and extracted with 500 cm3 of dichloromethane. The organic phase is washed with 200 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). 20.2 g of 3-chloromethylbenzonitrile are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 3-Chloromethylbenzoamide may be prepared in the following manner: 150 cm[0602] 3 of a solution of ammonium hydroxide (d=0.90) are poured into a solution of 50 g of 3-chloromethylbenzoyl chloride in 150 cm3 of ethyl ether, the mixture is cooled, stirred for 1 hour, filtered and washed with twice 200 cm3 of ethyl ether. 32 g of 3-chloromethylbenzoamide are obtained in the form of white crystals.
  • Example 80
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 79 starting with 0.5 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-0.3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(pentafluorophenoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methylene}azetidine, 0.06 cm[0603] 3, 1,1-dimethylhydrazine and 5 cm3 of dimethylformamide, 0.125 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{(3-(2,2-dimethylcarbohydrazido)phenyl] (methylsulfonyl)methylene}azetidine is obtained in the form of a white solid melting at 134° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.60 (6H, s, N(CH3)2), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 7.35 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.45 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.50 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 7.80 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 9.50 (1H, s, CONH)].
  • Example 81
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure described in Example 1 starting with 2.2 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.64 cm[0604] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride, 2.3 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine and 75 cm3 of dichloromethane, 1.3 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine are obtained, after purification by chromatography and crystallization from diisopropyl ether, in the form of white crystals melting at 165° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.00 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.92 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.28 (2H, s, NCH2), 5.40 (1H, s, NCH), 6.95 (2H, dd, J=5 and 2 Hz, 2CH thio.), 7.15 (2H, d, J=2 Hz, 2CH thio.), 7.20 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 7.35 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, CH arom.), 7.50 (2H, d, J=5 Hz, 2CH thio.)].
  • 1-[Bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained according to the procedure described in Example 1, starting with 1.5 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one, 4 cm[0605] 3 of 1.6 N n-butyllithium in hexane, 1.3 g of (3,5-dichlorobenzyl)methylsulfone and 40 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran. 2.2 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained, after purification by chromatography, in the form of white crystals melting at 145° C.
  • 1-[Bis-thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 73, starting with 4 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol, 2.6 cm[0606] 3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, 7.7 cm3 of triethylamine, 7.7 cm3 of oxalyl chloride, and 100 cm3 of dichloromethane. The residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm) with, as eluent, a mixture of cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (1/1 by volume). The fractions obtained are evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). 3.2 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of cream-colored crystals melting at 70° C.
  • 1-[Bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 73, starting with 6 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine, 2.5 cm[0607] 3 of epibromohydrin, 2.6 g of sodium bicarbonate and 50 cm3 of ethanol. 4 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of beige crystals melting at 115° C.
  • 1-[Bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine may be prepared in the following manner: a solution of 5 cm[0608] 3 of thien-2-ylcarbonitrile in 50 cm3 of diethyl ether is poured dropwise into a suspension, cooled under argon to 10° C., of thien-2-ylmagnesium bromide (prepared from 1.29 g of magnesium and 3.22 cm3 2-bromothiophene in 75 cm3 of diethyl ether). After refluxing for 1 hour and 30 minutes, the reaction medium is cooled to 5° C. and then 20 cm of methanol are poured in dropwise, the suspension filtered and the solid washed with methanol. The filtrate obtained a brown solution. 2.45 g of sodium borohydride are added to this solution, under argon, in several portions. The mixture is stirred at room temperature for 16 hours and then diluted with ethyl acetate and supplemented with water slowly. The organic phase is extracted, washed with water, dried over magnesium sulfate and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa) at 55° C. A brown oil is obtained which is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.2-0.063 mm, diameter 8 cm, height 25 cm) and eluted with a mixture of cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (90/10 and then 85/15 by volume). Fractions 21 to 30 are combined and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). 11 g of 1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]amine are obtained in the form of a crystallized solid.
  • Example 82
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure described in Example 1 starting with 0.47 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.13 cm[0609] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride, 25 cm3 of dichloromethane and 0.48 g of 1-(bis-p-tolylmethyl)-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.25 g of 1-(bis-p-tolylmethyl)-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after purification by chromatography and crystallization from diisopropyl ether, in the form of a white solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (250 MHz): 2.23 (6H, s, 2 PhCH3), 2.98 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.76 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 5.55 (1H, s, NCH), 7.10 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.), 7.32 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.), 7.43 (5H, s, phenyl)].
  • 1-(Bis-p-tolylmethyl)-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared according to the procedure described in Example 39, starting with 0.59 g of bromo(bis-p-tolyl)methane, 20 cm[0610] 3 of acetonitrile, 0.3 g of potassium carbonate and 0.6 g of 3-[(methylsulfonyl)-(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride. The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 16 cm) with, as eluent, a cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (7/3 by volume) mixture. The fractions are concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). 0.48 g of 1-(bis-p-tolylmethyl)-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Bromo(di-p-tolyl)methane may be prepared according to the procedure described by BACHMANN W. E., J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2135 (1933). [0611]
  • 3-[(Methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride may be prepared according to the procedure described in Example 39 starting with 7 g of 3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol, 35 cm[0612] 3 of dioxane, 35 cm3 of a 6.2 N solution of hydrochloric acid in dioxane. 5 g of 3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • 3-[(Methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol may be prepared according to the procedure described in Example 38 (Method 1), starting with 10 g of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 600 cm[0613] 3 of dichloromethane and 2.52 cm3 of vinyl chloroformate. The residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.2 mm, diameter 5.2 cm, height 36 cm with, as eluent, a cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (7/3 by volume) mixture. The fractions are evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 Kpa). 7 g of 3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methyl-(RS)]-1-(vinyloxycarbonyl)azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Example 83
  • A solution of 30 mg of sodium borohydride in 2 cm[0614] 3 of methanol is poured into a solution of 0.77 g of (−)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 20 cm3 of methanol at 0° C. under argon. After stirring for 4 hours at 0° C., water is added and the mixture is then extracted with dichloromethane. The organic phase is washed with a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate and then evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). The white foam obtained is purified on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3.2 cm, height 17 cm) with, as eluent, a cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (60/40 by volume) mixture. 0.1 g of (+)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-hydroxymethylphenyl)-methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after crystallization from 1.5 cm3 of absolute ethanol, in the form of white crystals melting at 190° C., [a]20 D=+4.2°(c=0.5% in methanol) [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.05 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.95 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.22 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.48 (2H, d, J=6 Hz, CH2O), 4.75 (1H, s, NCH), 5.15 (1H, t, J=6 Hz, OH), 7.20 (2H, m, 2CH arom.), 7.28 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.40(5H, m, 5 CH arom.), 7.50 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.)].
  • (−)-1-[(4-Chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)methylsulfonylmethylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 3.32 cm[0615] 3 of a 5 N solution of hydrochloric acid are poured into a solution of 0.83 g of (+)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 5 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran and then the mixture is kept stirring for 20 hours. Dichloromethane and water are added to the reaction medium followed by a 30% aqueous solution of sodium hydroxide until a pH=14 is obtained. The aqueous phase is extracted with dichloromethane, the organic phase is washed successively with water, with a saturated aqueous solution of sodium chloride, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). 0.8 g of (−)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • (+)-1-{(4-Chlorophenyl) [4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine may be obtained in the following manner: 0.93 g of 1,8-Diazabicyclo[5-4-O]undec-7-ene is poured dropwise into a solution of 2.42 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 3-acetoxy-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(R*)}-3-[(3,5-difluoro-phenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]azetidine and 3-acetoxy-1-{(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(R*)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(S*)]azetidine in 25 cm[0616] 3 of tetrahydrofuran under argon at 0° C. After stirring for 1 hour and 30 minutes at 0° C., the reaction medium is diluted with ethyl acetate, washed with water and with a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution. The organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure. The crude product is purified on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.8 cm, height 17.5 cm) with, as eluent, a cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (80/20 by volume) mixture. 1.21 g of (+)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a yellow foam.
  • The mixture of the two diastereoisomers 3-acetoxy-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(R*)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]azetidine and 3-acetoxy-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(R*)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(S*)]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 3.27 cm[0617] 3 of n-butyllithium are poured dropwise into a solution of 1.08 g of 3-5-difluorobenzyl methyl sulfone under argon, cooled to −70° C., and then the mixture is kept stirring for 1 hour at −70° C. and then a solution of 1.80 g of (+)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-one in 10 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran is poured in dropwise. After stirring for 3 hours at −70° C. and for 1 hour at −20° C., a solution of 0.74 cm3 of acetyl chloride in 10 cm3 of anhydrous diethyl ether at −20° C. is poured in and the mixture is stirred for 2 hours at −20° C. The reaction medium is thrown over water, the mixture is extracted with ethyl acetate, the organic phase washed with water and with a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). 2.42 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 3-acetoxy-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(R*)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(R*)]azetidine and 3-acetoxy-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl-(R*)}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(S*)]azetidine are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • (+)-1-{(4-Chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-one may be prepared in the following manner: 2.24 cm[0618] 3 of triethylamine are poured into a solution of 1.38g of (+)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-ol in 20 cm3 of anhydrous dimethyl sulfoxide under argon, followed dropwise by 1.65 g of a solution of sulfur trioxide pyridine complex in 20 cm3 of anhydrous dimethyl sulfoxide. After stirring for 1 hour and 15 minutes at room temperature, the reaction medium is thrown over ice, extracted with ethyl acetate, the organic phase washed with water, with a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). The oily residue obtained (1.31 g), combined with another batch of the same crude compound (1.21 g), are purified together on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4.8 cm, height 18 cm), with, as eluent, a cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (80/20 by volume) mixture. 1.87 g of (+)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-one are obtained in the form of a yellow oil. [a]20365 nm=+5.9° (c=0.5; methanol).
  • (+)-1-{(4-Chlorophenyl) [4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-ol may be described according to the procedure described in Example 73, starting with 4.43 g of (+)-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}amine, 40 cm[0619] 3 of absolute ethanol, 1.25 cm3 of epibromohydrin and 1.28 g of sodium bicarbonate. 1.66 g of (+)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • Chiral (+)-{(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}amine may be obtained in the following manner: 3.95 cm[0620] 3 of ethylene glycol are poured into a suspension of 18.16 g of chiral (R*)-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]amine hydrochloride, in 1000 cm3 of toluene, and 0.82 g of para-toluenesulfonic acid monohydrate is added. After stirring for 20 hours at the reflux temperature, the reaction medium is cooled, washed with a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution, with water and with a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution. The organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure. The residue obtained is purified on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 8.4 cm, height 21.5 cm) with, as eluent, a cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (30/70 by volume) mixture, collecting 250 cm3 fractions. Fractions 23 to 30 are concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). 1.39 g of chiral (+)-{(4-chlorophenyl)-[4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}amine are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • Chiral (R*)-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]amine hydrochloride may be prepared in the following manner: 330 cm of methanol are poured into a solution of 51.4 g of the diastereoisomer N-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethoxymethyl)phenyl]methyl-(R*)}-(R)-2-phenylglycinol in 660 cm[0621] 3 of anhydrous dichloromethane, the mixture cooled with an ice bath, 60.96 g of lead tetraacetate added, the mixture stirred for 5 minutes and then 1 liter of a phosphate buffer solution pH 7 poured in. After stirring for 30 minutes at room temperature, the mixture is filtered and the aqueous phase is extracted with dichloromethane. The organic phase is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). The residue is taken up in 1 liter of diethyl ether and supplemented with 1 liter of a 3 N aqueous solution of hydrochloric acid, the mixture is stirred for 15 minutes at room temperature, the aqueous phase is separated, washed with ethyl acetate and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). 18.16 g of chiral (R*)-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-formylphenyl)methyl]amine hydrochloride are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • N-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethoxymethyl)phenyl]methyl-(R*)}-(R)-2-phenylglycinol may be prepared in the following manner: 286 cm[0622] 3 of 1.6 M n-butyllithium in hexane are poured dropwise into a solution, cooled to −70° C., under argon, of 87.7 g of 4-bromochlorobenzene and the mixture is stirred for 15 minutes at −70° C. This solution obtained is then added dropwise to the following solution cooled to 0° C.: 30 g of (R)-N-[4-(diethoxymethyl)benzylidene]-2-phenylglycinol in 300 cm3 of diethyl ether. The mixture is stirred for 2 hours at 0° C. and then thrown over water. The organic phase is washed with water and then with a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). 71.5 g of a reddish oil are obtained, which oil is purified on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 11 cm, height 45 cm), with, as eluent, a cyclohexane/ethyl acetate (85/15 by volume, then 80/20 and 75/25) mixture, collecting 1 liter fractions. Fractions 11 to 17 are concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). 39.85 g of the sole diastereoisomer N-{(4-chlorophenyl)-[4-(diethoxymethyl)phenyl]methyl-(R*)}—(R)-2-phenylglycinol are obtained in the form of an orange red oil.
  • (R)-N-[4-(diethoxymethyl)benzylidene]-2-phenylglycinol may be prepared in the following manner: 35.9 cm[0623] 3 of 4-(diethoxymethyl)benzaldehyde are poured into a white suspension of 24.7 g of (R)-(−)-2-phenylglycinol in 500 cm3 of toluene. The cloudy yellow solution is heated under reflux for 6 hours 30 minutes, and is then stirred at room temperature for 20 hours. After concentrating the reaction medium to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa), 61.6 g of (R)-N-[4-(diethoxymethyl)benzylidene]-2-phenylglycinol are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • Example 84
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1, but starting with 5.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(N-tertbutyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl] (methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-ol, 100 cm[0624] 3 of dichloromethane, 1.59 g of methanesulfonyl chloride and 4.5 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine. The mixture is kept stirring for 3 hours at room temperature. The crude product obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm and weight of silica 250 g), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with an ethyl acetate/cyclohexane (30/70 by volume) mixture and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 18 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa). 3.2 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(N-tertbutyloxy-carbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a white foam [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 1.30 (9H, s, OC(CH3)3), 2.65 (3H, s, J=6 Hz, NCH3), 2.85 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.50 (2H, s, NCH2), 3.90 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.45 (1H, s, NCH) between 6.85 and 7.05 (8H, m, 8 CH arom.), 7.10 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4 CH arom.)].
  • 1-[Bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(N-tertbutyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl] (methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)} azetidin-3-ol may be prepared according to the procedure described in Example 1 starting with 3.8 g of [3-(N-tertbutyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)benzyl]methylsulfone, 50 cm[0625] 3 of tetrahydrofuran, 9.5 cm3 of a 1.6 N solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 3.82 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one. The crude product is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 4 cm, weight of silica 250 g), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (99/1 by volume) and collecting 500 cm3 fractions. Fractions 10 to 16 are combined, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 5.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(N-tertbutyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)}azetidin-3-ol, are obtained in the form of a foam.
  • Example 85
  • 2.7 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(N-tertbutyloxycarbonyl-N-methylamino)phenyl] (methylsulfonyl)-methylene}azetidine in 30 cm[0626] 3 of dioxane and 30 cm3 of a 4.7 N solution of hydrochloric dioxane are stirred for 20 hours. The reaction medium is evaporated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa), taken up in 50 cm3 of water and 50 cm of ethyl acetate, stirred and neutralized carefully with a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic phase is separated, dried over magnesium sulfate, treated with animal charcoal and then concentrated under reduced pressure (2.7 kpa) to a volume of about 25 cm3, then filtered, concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure. 1.3 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methylaminophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of white crystals melting at 228° C. [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 2.65 (3H, s, J=6 Hz, NCH3), 2.95 (3H, s, SCH3), 3.80 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.20 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.80 (1H, s, NCH), 5.85 (1H, q, J=6 Hz, NH), 6.55 (3H, m, 3 CH arom.), 7.15 (1H, t, J=7 Hz, CH arom.), 7.40 (4H, d, J=7 Hz, 4CH arom.), 7.50 (4H, m, 4CH arom.)].
  • Example 86
  • On carrying out the operation as in Example 1, starting with 0.40 g of a mixture of two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol, 0.10 cm[0627] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.37 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 0.13 g of (RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained, after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.2 cm, height 20 cm), at an argon pressure of 1 bar with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (40/60 by volume) as eluent and collecting 20 cm3 fractions, in the form of a pinkish solid [NMR spectrum in DMSO-d6, T=300K, □ in ppm (300 MHz): 3.05 (3H, s, SCH3), 4.05 (2H, s, NCH2), 4.35 (2H, m, NCH2), 5.25 (1H, s, NCH), 7.20 (2H, d, J=8 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.35 (1H, t, J=8 Hz, CH arom.), 7.45 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.50 (2H, d, J=7 Hz, 2CH arom.), 7.70 (1H, d, J=2 Hz, CH thiazole), 7.75 (1H, d, J=2 Hz, CH thiazole)].
  • The mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol may be obtained in the following manner: on carrying out the operation as in Example 72, starting with 1.01 g of (RS)-bromo(4-chlorophenyl)thiazol-2-ylmethane and 0.55 g of (RS)-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol hydrochloride and after chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 4.4 cm, height 38 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar and eluting with a mixture of ethyl acetate and cyclohexane (30/70 by volume and then 40/60 from fraction 16) and collecting 60 cm[0628] 3 fractions, fractions 21 to 35 are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.40 g of the mixture of the two diastereoisomers 1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl-(RS)]-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methyl-sulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol which is obtained in the form of a whitish solid.
  • Example 87
  • 50 mm[0629] 3 of pyrrolidine are added to a solution of 0.32 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, and 5 mg of sodium iodide in 10 cm3 of dichloromethane. After stirring for 20 hours at 20° C., 50 mm3 of pyrrolidine are added to the mixture, stirred for 8 hours and then 50 mm3 of pyrrolidine are again added and the mixture is stirred for 20 hours at 20° C. The reaction mixture is washed with water and then the organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under vacuum (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.2 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.1 bar, eluting with dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (97.5/2.5 by volume) and collecting 3 cm3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 40 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.18 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-pyrrolidinylmethyl)phenyl]-methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-ene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [a]2365 nm=−22.5°+/−0.7 (c=0.5%; dichloromethane) [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 1.78 (mt, 4H), 2.51 (mt, 4H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 3.58 (s, 2H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • 1-{(R*)-[(4-chloromethyl)phenyl] (4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner:. 12.4 cm[0630] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride are added to a solution of 28.0 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (forms A) 1-{(R*)-[(4-chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol and 1-{(R*)-[(4-chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol and 32 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, in 500 cm3 of dichloromethane. After stirring for 1 hour at 10° C. and then 1 hour at 20° C., the reaction mixture is washed with 500 cm3 of water, the organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 6 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.2 bar, eluting with dichloromethane and collecting 250 cm3 fractions. Fractions 9 to 25 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 6.3 g of 1-[((R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)-phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, are obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • The mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (forms A) 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol, and 1-(R*)-[(4-chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]-azetidin-3-ol, may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 60 mm[0631] 3 of thionyl chloride are added to a solution of 0.20 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (forms A) 1-{(R*)-[4-(chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol, and 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol, in 10 cm3 of dichloromethane. After-stirring for 20 hours at 20° C., 5 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium hydrogen carbonate solution are added to the reaction mixture and then the mixture is stirred for 15 minutes. The mixture is separated after settling out, the organic phase is washed with water, dried over magnesium sulfate and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 1.0 cm, height 20 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.2 bar, eluting with a cyclohexane and ethyl acetate mixture (75/25 by volume) and collecting 20 cm3 fractions. Fractions 4 to 7 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.17 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (forms A) 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl]-[4-chlorophenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol, and 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(S)(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]-azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • The mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (forms A) 1-{(R*)-4-(chlorophenyl)phenyl][4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol, and 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol, may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 1.6 cm[0632] 3 of a 1.5 M solution of diisobutylaluminum hydride in toluene are added to a solution, maintained under argon and cooled to −30° C., of 0.58 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (forms A) 3-acetoxy-1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidine and 3-acetoxy-1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl]-azetidine, in 10 cm3 of anhydrous toluene. After stirring for 15 minutes at −30° C., 1.0 cm3 of this same hydride solution is again added and then the mixture is allowed to return to 0° C. After stirring for 30 minutes, the stirred mixture is supplemented with 3 cm3 of water and 6 cm3 of 1 N sodium hydroxide and then extracted with 25 cm3 of dichloromethane. The organic phase is washed with 5 cm3 of water, 5 cm3 of brine, and then dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.2 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.1 bar, eluting with a cyclohexane and ethyl acetate mixture (50/50 by volume) and collecting 30 cm3 fractions. Fractions 4 to 12 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.42 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (forms A) 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol, and 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(S)(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl)]azetidin-3-ol is obtained in the form of a white lacquer.
  • The mixture of the 2 diastereomers (forms A) 3-acetoxy-1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)}azetidine and 3-acetoxy-1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)} azetidine may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 40, starting with 1.0 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone, 30 cm[0633] 3 of tetrahydrofuran, 3 cm3 of a 1.6 N solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 1.45 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)-phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-one, form A isomer, and
  • 0.43 cm[0634] 3 of acetyl chloride. 1.28 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (forms A) 3-acetoxy-1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidine and 3-acetoxy-1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidine are obtained in the form of a beige foam.
  • 1-{(R*)-[(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)-phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-one, form A isomer, may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 40, starting with 0.55 cm[0635] 3 of oxalyl chloride, 25 cm3 of dichloromethane, 0.90 cm3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, 1.75 g of 1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-ol, and 2.70 cm3 of triethylamine. 1.45 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]-methyl}azetidin-3-one, form A isomer, are obtained in the form of a yellow foam.
  • 1-{(R*)(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]-methyl}azetidin-3-ol, form A isomer, may be prepared by carrying out the operation according to the procedure described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al., in J. Heterocycl. Chem., (1994), 271 from 2.0 g of methyl (+)-4-[(R*)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate, [0636]
  • 30 cm[0637] 3 of ethanol, 0.60 g of sodium hydrogen carbonate and 0.60 cm3 of epibromhydrin. 1.76 g of 1-(R)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]-methyl}azetidin-3-ol, form A isomer, are obtained in the form of a pasty solid.
  • Methyl (+)-4-[(R*)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 2.51 g of D-(−)-tartaric acid are added to a solution of 9.2 g of methyl (4-[(RS)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate in 10 cm[0638] 3 of methanol. The solution is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The cream-colored foam obtained is dissolved in 50 cm3 of ethanol containing 5% water and the resulting solution is allowed to crystallize for 20 hours at 20° C. The crystals are filtered, washed with ethanol containing 5% water, drained and then dried under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 3.4 g of white crystals are obtained which are called “A crystals” [and which are stored for the subsequent preparation of the second enantiomer, methyl (−)-4-[(R*)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate]. The mother liquors are concentrated to dryness and a white foam (8.1 g) is obtained which is dissolved in 100 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The solution obtained is supplemented with 50 cm3 of 1 N sodium hydroxide, stirred and separated after settling out. The organic phase is washed with 50 cm3 of water and then dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). A yellow solid is obtained which is dissolved in 100 cm3 of methanol. The solution obtained is supplemented with 1.85 g of L-(+)-tartaric acid and the resulting solution is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). A cream-colored foam is obtained which, once dissolved in 27 cm3 of ethanol containing 4% water, is allowed to crystallize for 20 hours at 20° C. The crystals are filtered, washed with ethanol containing 4% water, drained and then dried under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 3.4 g of methyl (+)-4-[(R*)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate L-(+)-tartrate crystals are obtained which are recrystallized from 60 cm3 of ethanol containing 5% water. After draining and then drying, 2.78 g of white crystals are obtained which are dissolved in 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The solution obtained is supplemented with 100 cm3 of 1 N sodium hydroxide, stirred and separated after settling out. The organic phase is washed with 50 cm3 of water and then dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 2.1 g of methyl (+)-4-[(R*)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate are obtained in the form of a white solid.
  • Methyl 4-[(RS)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 3.9 cm[0639] 3 of hydrazine hydrate are added to a suspension of 16.3 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-phthalimido-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate in 200 cm3 of methanol. After stirring for 5 hours at the reflux temperature and then for 20 hours at 20° C., the reaction mixture is filtered and the filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is taken up in a mixture of 200 cm[0640] 3 of water and 200 cm3 of ethyl acetate. After stirring for 15 minutes, the resulting suspension is filtered, the filtrate separated after settling out in a separating funnel, and the organic phase is washed with 50 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 8.4 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate are obtained in the form of a pale yellow 25 oil.
  • Methyl 4-[(RS)-phthalimido-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 12.6 g of potassium phthalimide are added to a solution of 11.6 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-bromo-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate in 70 cm[0641] 3 of dimethylformamide. After stirring for 3 hours at the reflux temperature, the reaction mixture is cooled to 20° C. and then supplemented with 300 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 300 cm3 of water. After stirring, the mixture is separated after settling out, the aqueous phase reextracted with twice 100 cm3 of ethyl acetate, the combined organic phases are washed with twice 400 cm3 of water and then dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • (2.7 kPa). 16.3 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-phthalimido-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate are obtained in the form of a pasty yellow solid. [0642]
  • Methyl 4-[(RS)-bromo-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 10.18 g of N,N′-carbonyldiimidazole and 54.3 cm[0643] 3 of allyl bromide are added to a solution of 17.4 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(hydroxy)methyl]benzoate in 200 cm3 of acetonitrile. After stirring for 30 minutes at 20° C., the reaction mixture is heated under reflux for 2 hours, stirred for 20 hours at 20° C. and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). The mixture, taken up in dichloromethane, is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 7 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.5 bar, eluting with dichloromethane and collecting 500 cm3 fractoins. Fractions 3 to 6 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 11.6 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-bromo-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate are obtained in the form of an oil which will be used as it is in the next step.
  • Methyl 4-[(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)(hydroxy)methyl]benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 1.21 g of sodium borohydride are slowly added in small fractions to a suspension of 2.75 g of methyl 4-(4-chlorobenzoyl)benzoate in 200 cm[0644] 3 of methanol at 20° C. (heating of the medium up to 50° C. occurs). After stirring for 20 hours at 20° C., the reaction mixture is concentrated to a reduced volume and then supplemented with 150 cm3 of dichloromethane and, while stirring, with 100 cm3 of 0.5 N hydrochloric acid. After separating after settling out, the organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 2.5 g of methyl 4-[(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)-(hydroxy)methyl]benzoate are obtained in the form of a colorless oil which slowly crystallizes at 20° C., and which will be used as it is in the next step.
  • Methyl 4-(4-chlorobenzoyl)benzoate may be prepared by carrying out the operation in the following manner: 27.4 cm[0645] 3 of tri-n-butylphosphine are added, under argon, to a solution, cooled to −22° C., of 19.3 g of terephthalic acid chloride monomethyl ester in 200 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran. After stirring for 20 minutes at −22° C., a solution of 4-chlorophenylmagnesium bromide (prepared from 19.15 g of 4-bromochlorobenzene, 2.43 g of magnesium and an iodine crystal in 100 cm3 of diethyl ether under reflux) is poured in while this temperature is maintained. After stirring for 30 minutes at −22° C., 150 cm3 of 1 N hydrochloric acid are slowly added, the mixture is allowed to return to 20° C. and then the medium is diluted with 200 cm3 of diethyl ether. The white suspension obtained is filtered, the solid is washed with twice 50 cm3 of water and then with twice 50 cm3 of diethyl ether. 16.2 g of methyl 4-(4-chlorobenzoyl)benzoate are obtained, after draining and then drying under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa), in the form of a white solid melting at 170° C.
  • Example 88
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl]-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0646] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.025 g of 3,3-dimethylpiperidine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then eluting with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.040 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(3,3-dimethylpiperidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 0.94 (s, 6H), 1.21 (mt, 2H), from 1.50 to 1.65 (mt, 2H), 1.99 (broad s, 2H), 2.27 (unresolved complex, 2H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 3.36 (s, 2H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 89
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of methylsulfonyl methyl 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0647] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.025 g of thiomorpholine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.038 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(thiomorpholin-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): from 2.60 to 2.75 (mt, 8H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.44 (s, 2H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.83 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.97 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 90
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl] (4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0648] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.025 g of N-cyclohexyl-N-ethylamine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and ethanol mixture (95/5) by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. 0.022 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethyl-N-cyclohexylaminomethyl)phenyl]-methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3 with addition of a few drops of CD3COOD-d4, □ in ppm): from 1.15 to 1.25 (mt, 2H), 1.29 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 3H), from 1.45 to 1.65 (mt, 4H), 1.88 (mt, 2H), 2.17 (mt, 2H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 3.05 (q, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 3.27 (mt, 1H), 3.95 (mt, 2H), 4.18 (s, 2H), 4.40 (mt, 2H), 4.66 (s, 1H), 6.82 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 4H), 7.41 (d, J=8 Hz, 2H), 7.53 (d, J=8 Hz, 2H)].
  • Example 91
  • The procedure is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0649] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.032 g of 4-(ethoxycarbonyl)piperazine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.021 g of 1-{{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[(4-ethoxycarbonylpiperazinyl)methyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 1.25 (t, J=7 Hz, 3H), 2.36 (mt, 4H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.44 (s, 2H), 3.46 (mt, 4H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 4.13 (q, J=7 Hz, 2H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.83 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 92
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0650] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.023 g of N-cyclopropyl-N-propylamine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.026 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[(4-N-cyclopropyl-N-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3 with addition of a few drops of CD3COOD-d4, □ in ppm): 0.34 (mt, 2H), 0.70 (mt, 2H), 0.91 (t, J=7 Hz, 3H), 1.08 (mt, 1H), 1.76 (mt, 2H), 2.82 (s, 3H), 2.92 (d, J=7 Hz, 2H), 3.00 (mt, 2H), 3.90 (mt, 2H), 4.25 (s, 2H), 4.37 (mt, 2H), 4.59 (s, 1H), 6.83 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.45 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 93
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, but by stirring the reaction mixture for 6 days at 20° C., starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl] (4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0651] 3 of dichloromethane, 5 mg of sodium iodide and 0.020 g of diisopropylamine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height
  • 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm[0652] 3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.028 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diisopropylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 1.00 (unresolved complex, 12H), 2.80 (s, 3H), from 2.90 to 3.10 (unresolved complex, 2H), 3.58 (mt, 2H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.48 (s, 1H), 6.82 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.97 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 94
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0653] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.027 g of bis(2-methoxyethyl)amine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 10 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.014 g of 1-{{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl){4-[bis(2-methoxyethyl)aminomethyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.70 (broad t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 3.29 (s, 6H), 3.46 (broad t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H) 3.65 (broad s, 2H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 95
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0654] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.020 g of di-n-propylamine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.025 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-(chlorophenyl)[4-(di-n-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 0.85 (t, J=7 Hz, 6H) 1.45 (mt, 4H), 2.34 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 4H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.48 (s, 2H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.83 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 96
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0655] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.017 g of piperidine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 5 to 10 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.035 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]-methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl-ene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): from 1.35 to 1.65 (mt, 6H), 2.35 (unresolved complex, 4H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.41 (broad s, 2H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 97
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0656] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.020 g of N-methylpiperazine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.025 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.28 (s, 3H), from 2.30 to 2.60 (unresolved complex, 8H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.45 (s, 2H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 98
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0657] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.018 g of morpholine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.022 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(morpholin-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.41 (t, J=5 Hz, 4H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.43 (s, 2H), 3.69 (t, J=5 Hz, 4H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 99
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0658] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.020 cm3 of D-prolinol. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.025 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-((2R)-hydroxymethylpyrrolidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]-methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6 with addition of a few drops of CD3COOD-d4, □ in ppm): from 1.60 to 2.15 (mt, 4H), from 2.90 to 3.05 (mt, 1H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.13 (mt, 1H), 3.38 (mt, 1H), from 3.50 to 3.60 (mt, 1H), 3.56 (d, J=5 Hz, 2H), 3.90 (mt, 2H), 4.04 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 2H), 4.21 (mt, 2H), 4.40 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 2H), 4.78 (s, 1H), 7.14 (mt, 2H), 7.27 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), from 7.30 to 7.55 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 100
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0659] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.015 g of diethylamine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 4 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.025 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 1.03 (t, J=7 Hz, 6H), 2.50 (q, J=7 Hz, 4H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 3.50 (s, 2H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 101
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0660] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.026 g of N-(hydroxyethyl)piperazine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 10 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.032 g of 1-{{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)4-[4-(hydroxyethyl)piperazin-1-ylmethyl]phenyl}-methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): from 2.40 to 2.60 (mt, 8H), 2.54 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 2H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.44 (s, 2H), 3.60 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 2H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 102
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87 but by stirring the reaction mixture for 4 days at 20° C., starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0661] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.023 g of 2(RS),6(RS)-dimethylpiperidine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.024 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(2(RS), 6(RS)dimethyl(piperidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]-methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3 with addition of a few drops of CD3COOD-d4, at a temperature of 353K, □ in ppm): from 1.20 to 1.45 (mt, 2H), 1.60(d,J=7 Hz, 6H), from 1.80 to 2.10 (mt, 4H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.17 (mt, 2H), 3.90 (mt,2H), 4.34 (broad d, J=16 Hz, 1H), 4.40 (mt, 2H), 4.43 (broad d, J=16 Hz, 1H), 4.62 (s,1H), 6.82 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.50 (mt,8H)].
  • Example 103
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, but by stirring the reaction mixture for 4 days at 20° C., starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0662] 3 of dichloromethane, and 0.024 g of piperazin-2-one. The crude product is chromato-graphed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.022 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperazin-2-on-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.62 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 2H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.11 (s, 2H), 3.34 (mt, 2H), 3.51 (s, 2H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.51 (s, 1H), 5.76 (unresolved complex, 1H), 6.84 (broad t, JHF=9 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H) from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 104
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl(4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0663] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.020 g of L-prolinol. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and 3 methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.028 g of 1-{{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl){4-[(2S)-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-ylmethyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): from 1.50 to 2.00 (mt, 4H), 2.24 (mt, 1H), 2.71 (mt, 1H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 2.93 (mt, 1H), 3.28 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 3.45 (mt, 1H), 3.65 (d, J=11 and 4 Hz, 1H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 3.91 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.83 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 105
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0664] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.023 g of (2S)-(methoxymethyl)pyrrolidine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 6 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.037 g of 1-{{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl) 4-[(2S)-(methoxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-ylmethyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 1.66 (mt, 2H), 1.90 (mt, 1H), 2.16 (mt, 1H), 2.68 (mt, 1H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 2.89 (mt, 1H), from 3.25 to 3.45 (mt, 4H), 3.31 (s, 3H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.04 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H) from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 106
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0665] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.020 g of 2(RS),5(RS)-dimethylpyrrolidine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 6 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.024 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(2(RS),5(RS)-dimethylpyrrolidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]-methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, mixture of isomers, form A, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3 with addition of a few drops of CD3COOD-d4, □ in ppm): 1.68 (d, J=7 Hz, 6H), from 2.00 to 2.15 (mt, 4H), 2.82 (s, 3H), 3.22 (mt, 2H), 3.92 (mt, 2H), 4.30 (s, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 1H), 4.45 (d, J=16.5 and 3 Hz, 1H), 4.63 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.55 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 107
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl]-4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0666] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.023 g of L-prolinamide. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 5 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.028 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-((2S)-carbamoylpyrrolidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): from 1.65 to 1.85 (mt, 2H), 1.92 (mt, 1H), from 2.15 to 2.35 (mt, 2H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.00 (mt, 1H), 3.16 (dd, J=10 and 5.5 Hz, 1H), 3.41 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 3.86 (mt, 2H), 3.89 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.51 (s, 1H), 5.23 (unresolved complex, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), 7.17 (unresolved complex, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 108
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, but by stirring the reaction mixture for 4 days at 20° C., starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, 1.0 cm[0667] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.021 g of diethanolamine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 8 cm), eluting with 80 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 2.5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.004 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(dihydroxyethylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.69 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.61 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 3.65 (s, 2H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.83 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 109
  • 0.055 g of imidazole is added to solution of 0.24 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, [0668]
  • in 5 cm[0669] 3 of dichloromethane. After heating for 3 hours under reflux, the mixture is supplemented with 5 mg of sodium iodide. After stirring for 20 hours under reflux, the reaction mixture is cooled to 20° C. and then chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.0 cm, height 20 cm), eluting with 120 cm of dichloromethane without fractionating, and then with a
  • dichloromethane and methanol mixture (98/2 and then 96/4 by volume), collecting 4 cm[0670] 3 fractions. Fractions 12 to 14 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.039 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(imidazol-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine, form A isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • Example 110
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 87, starting with 0.50 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form B isomer, 5 mg of sodium iodide, 15 cm[0671] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.0190 g of pyrrolidine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.5 cm, height 20 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.1 bar, eluting with dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume) and collecting 25 cm3 fractions. Fractions 20 to 40 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • (2.7 kPa). 0.028 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(pyrrolidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]-methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form B isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam. [a][0672] 20365 nm=+26.8°+/−0.8 (c=0.5%, dichloromethane) [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 1.78 (mt, 4H), 2.50 (mt, 4H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.57 (s, 2H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-(chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form B isomer, may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 87, starting with 7.3 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (B forms) 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidin-3-ol and 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)-methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl]-azetidin-3-ol, 8.2 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, 150 cm[0673] 3 of dichloromethane and 3.2 cm3 of methanesulfonyl chloride. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.2 bar, eluting with dichloromethane and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 15 to 30 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 2.50 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl]-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-{(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form B isomer, are obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • The mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol and 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)-methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl)]-azetidin-3-ol, may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 87, starting with 11.0 g of a mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers 1-{(R*)-[4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl)methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol and 1-{(R*)-[4-(chlorophenyl](4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl)methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol, 250 cm[0674] 3 of dichloromethane and 3.1 cm3 of thionyl chloride. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.2 bar, eluting with a cyclohexane and ethyl acetate mixture (70/30 by volume) and collecting 50 cm3 fractions. Fractions 9 to 25 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 7.3 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (B forms) 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol and 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • The mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (B forms) 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol and 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidin-3-ol may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 87, starting with 18.0 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (B form) 3-acetoxy-1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidine and 3-acetoxy-1-(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methyloxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidine, 150 cm[0675] 3 of anhydrous toluene and 100 cm3 of a 20% solution of diisobutylaluminum hydride in toluene. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 30 cm), at an argon pressure of 0.1 bar, eluting with a cyclohexane and 3 ethyl acetate mixture (50/50 by volume) and collecting 50 cm3 fractions. Fractions 15 to 30 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 11.0 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (B forms) 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol and 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol are obtained in the form of white foam.
  • The mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (B forms) 3-acetoxy-1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidine and 3-acetoxy-1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidine may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 40, starting with 11.2 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)-methylsulfone, 350 cm[0676] 3 of tetrahydrofuran, 34 cm3 of a 1.6 N solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 11.2 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)-phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-one, form B isomer, and 5.5 cm3 of acetyl chloride. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 40 cm), eluting with a cyclohexane and ethyl acetate mixture (70/30 by volume) and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 10 to 30 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 21 g of a still impure cream-colored foam are obtained, which foam is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 40 cm), eluting with dichloromethane and collecting 100 cm3 fractions. Fractions 11 to 30 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 20.0 g of the mixture of the 2 diastereoisomers (B forms) 3-acetoxy-1 (R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(R)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidine and 3-acetoxy-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(S)-(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl)]azetidine are obtained in the form of a white foam.
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)-phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-one, form B isomer, may be prepared by carrying out the operation as described in Example 40, starting with 8.7 cm[0677] 3 of oxalyl chloride, 350 cm3 of dichloromethane, 14.2 cm3 of dimethyl sulfoxide, 29.0 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl} azetidin-3-ole, form B isomer, and 43 cm3 of triethylamine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 4 cm, height 40 cm), eluting with dichloromethane and collecting 250 cm3 fractions. Fractions 7 to 25 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • (2.7 kPa). 15.5 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-[chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)-phenyl]methyl} azetidin-3-one, form B isomer, are obtained in the form of an orange-colored oil. [0678]
  • 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(methoxycarbonyl)-phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-ol, form B isomer, may be prepared according to the procedure described by KATRITZKY A. R. et al., in J. Heterocycl. Chem., (1994), 271, starting with 25.5 g of methyl (−)-4-[1-(R*)-amino-1-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate, 250 cm[0679] 3 of ethanol, 7.9 g of sodium hydrogen carbonate, and 7.7 cm3 of epibromohydrin. 29 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-ol, form B isomer, are obtained in the form of a yellow oil.
  • Methyl (−)-4-[(R)amino(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate, may be prepared by carrying out two successive recrystallizations of the white crystals (3.4 g) called “A crystals” of Example 87, from 68 cm[0680] 3 of ethanol containing 5% water under reflux. The crystals obtained are filtered, drained and then dried under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 2.2 g of methyl
  • (−)-4-[(R*)amino(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate D-(−)-tartrate are obtained in the form of white crystals which are dissolved in 50 cm[0681] 3 of ethyl acetate. The solution obtained is supplemented with 50 cm3 of 1 N sodium hydroxide, stirred and then separated after settling out. The organic phase is washed with 50 cm3 of water and then dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • (2.7 kPa). 1.9 g of methyl (−)-4-[(R*)amino(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate are obtained in the form of a white solid [a]20° C., 365 nm=−58.1°+/−1 (c=0.5%) [0682]
  • Example 111
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 110, but by stirring the reaction mixture for 48 hours at 20° C., starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl] (4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene)]azetidine, form B isomer, 1.0 cm[0683] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.030 cm3 of N-methylpiperazine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 5 cm), eluting with 50 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 3 cm fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 4 to 10 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • (2.7 kPa). 0.025 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene)]-azetidine, form B isomer, is obtained in the form of a cream-colored foam [[0684] 1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.28 (s, 3H), 2.44 (unresolved complex, 8H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.45 (s, 2H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 112
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 110, but by stirring the reaction mixture for 48 hours at 20° C., starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene)]azetidine, form B isomer, 1.0 cm[0685] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.030 cm3 of L-Prolinol. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 5 cm), eluting with 50 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 3 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 8 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.025 g of 1-{{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl){4-[(2S)-(hydroxymethyl)-pyrrolidin-1-ylmethyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form B isomer, is obtained in the form of a cream-colored foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): from 1.80 to 2.00 (mt, 4H), 2.24 (mt, 1H), 2.72 (mt, 1H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 2.94 (mt, 1H), 3.28 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 3.45 (mt, 1H), 3.65 (d, J=10.5 and 3.5 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 3.92 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.15 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 113
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 110, but by stirring the reaction mixture for 48 hours at 20° C., starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl] (4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene)]azetidine, form B isomer, 1.0 cm[0686] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.030 cm3 of D-Prolinol. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 5 cm), eluting with 50 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 3 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.029 g of 1-{{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl){4-(2R)-(hydroxymethyl)pyrrolidin-1-ylmethyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form B isomer, is obtained in the form of a cream-colored foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): from 1.50 to 2.00 (mt, 4H), 2.24 (mt, 1H), 2.71 (mt, 1H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 2.93 (mt, 1H), 3.28 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 3.44 (split t, J=10.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 3.66 (dd, J=10.5 and 3.5 Hz, 1H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 3.92 (d, J=13.5 Hz, 1H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.15 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 114
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 110, but by stirring the reaction mixture for 48 hours at 20° C., starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl] (4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene)]azetidine, form B isomer, 1.0 cm[0687] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.030 cm3 of morpholine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 5 cm), eluting with 50 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 3 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.047 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(morpholin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-azetidine, form B isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.40 (mt, 4H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 3.43 (s, 2H), 3.69 (mt, 4H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 115
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 110, but by stirring the reaction mixture for 48 hours at 20° C., starting with 0.05 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene)]azetidine, form B isomer, 1.0 cm[0688] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.030 cm3 of thiomorpholine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 8 mm, height 5 cm), eluting with 50 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 3 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 2 to 9 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.047 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-(chlorophenyl)[4-(thiomorpholin-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form B isomer, is obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): from 2.60 to 2.75 (mt, 8H), 2.81 (s, 3H), 3.44 (s, 2H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=8.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.15 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • Example 116
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 110, but by stirring the reaction mixture for 48 hours at 20° C., starting with 0.200 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene)]azetidine, form B isomer, 5.0 cm[0689] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.120 cm3 of piperazin-2-one. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.0 cm, height 10 cm), eluting with 50 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 3 to 13 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • (2.7 kPa). 0.090 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-(chlorophenyl)[4-(piperazin-2-on-4-ylmethyl)-phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form B isomer, is obtained in the form of a white powder. [0690]
  • Example 117
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 110 starting with 0.200 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl] (4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene)]azetidine, form B isomer, 5.0 cm[0691] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.120 of 3,3-dimethylpiperidine. The crude product is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.0 cm, height 10 cm), eluting with 50 cm3 of dichloromethane and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (95/5 by volume), collecting 5 cm3 fractions immediately after using this eluent mixture. Fractions 4 to 11 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.120 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(3,3-dimethylpiperidinylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, form B isomer, is obtained in the form of a white powder.
  • Example 118
  • The operation is carried out as described in Example 110, by stirring for 72 hours at 20° C., starting with 0.200 g of 1-{(R*)-[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene)]-azetidine, form B isomer, 5.0 cm[0692] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.080 of imidazole. The reaction mixture is directly chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.06-0.200 mm, diameter 1.0 cm, height 10 cm), eluting with 100 cm3 of dichloromethane without fractionating, and then with a dichloromethane and methanol mixture (98/2 and then 96/4 by volume), collecting 5 cm3 fractions.
  • Fractions 5 to 12 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 0.35 g of 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(imidazol-1-ylmethyl)-phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]} azetidine, form B isomer, is obtained in the form of a white powder. [a][0693] 2D=−6.7° (c=0.5% dichloromethane)
  • Example 119
  • 2.47 g of potassium tert-butoxide are added to a suspension of 6.12 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one and 5.15 g of methyl 5-(methylsulfonylmethyl)thiophene-2-carboxylate in 200 cm[0694] 3 of tetrahydrofuran, under an argon atomosphere, cooled to −70° C. The mixture is stirred for 1 hour 30 min at a temperature close to −70° C., and then 1.7 cm3 of methanesulfonyl chloride in solution in 8 cm3 of ethyl ether is added. After stirring for 1 hour at a temperature close to −70° C., the mixture is allowed to return to room temperature and then 80 cm of distilled water are added. The mixture is concentrated in a rotary evaporator to one third of its initial volume, and is then extracted with 500 cm3 of dichloromethane. The organic phase is washed with three times 80 cm3 of distilled water, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • (2.7 kPa). The residue obtained is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.02-0.04 mm, diameter 7.5 cm, height 35 cm), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a cyclohexane and ethyl acetate mixture (70/30 by volume) and collecting 40 cm[0695] 3 fractions. Fractions 19 to 29 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 1.6 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-methoxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a cream-colored foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.91 (s, 3H), 3.88 (s, 3H), 4.08 (mt, 2H), 4.37 (mt, 2H), 4.53 (s, 1H), from 7.25 to 7.45 (mt, 9H), 7.71 (d, J=3.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Fractions 34 to 48 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 2.6 g of (RS)-1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-hydroxy-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-methoxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methyl]azetidine are obtained in the form of cream-colored powder [[0696] 1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 2.87 (s, 3H), 2.89 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 2.96 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 3.21 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 3.76 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 3.82 (s, 3H), 4.55 (s, 1H), 4.86 (s, 1H), 6.86 (s, 1H), from 7.35 to 7.45 (mt, 9H), 7.73 (d, J=4 Hz, 1H)].
  • Methyl 5-(methylsulfonylmethyl)thiophene-2-carboxylate may be prepared in the following manner: 6.94 g of sodium methanesulfinate are added, at room temperature, to a solution of 16 g of methyl 5-bromomethylthiophene-2-carboxylate in 150 cm[0697] 3 of tetrahydrofuran. The suspension is stirred for 2 hours 30 min under reflux, and then after addition of 50 cm3 of ethanol is again stirred for 3 hours under reflux. The mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa) and the residue obtained is supplemented with 150 cm3 of distilled water and is then extracted with twice 300 cm3 of ethyl acetate. The organic phase is successively washed with 100 cm3 of distilled water and twice 50 cm3 of saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution and then dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). 14 g of methyl 5-(methylsulfonylmethyl)thiophene-2-carboxylate are thus obtained in the form of a yellow solid melting around 133° C. [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, at a temperature of 373 K, □ in ppm): 3.05 (s, 3H), 4.22 (mt, 2H), 4.40 (mt, 2H), 4.98 (broad s, 1H), 7.30 (d, J=3.5 Hz, 1H), 7.39 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.50 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.66 (d, J=3.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Methyl 5-bromomethylthiophene-2-carboxylate may be prepared according to Curtin M. L., Davidsen S. K., Heyman H. R., Garland R. B., Sheppard G. S., J. Med. Chem., 1998, 41 (1), 74-95. [0698]
  • Example 120
  • 47 μl of N,N′-diisopropylcarbodiimide, 3.66 mg of 4-dimethylaminopyridine and 60 μl of isobutylamine are added to a solution of 163.5 mg of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-hydroxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methylene]azetidine hydrochloride in 3 cm[0699] 3 of dichloromethane, at room temperature. The mixture is stirred for 18 hours at room temperature and then chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.04-0.06 mm), eluting with a dichloromethane and ethyl acetate mixture (90/10 by volume). 60 mg of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[2-isobutylaminocarbonylthien-5-yl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine are thus obtained in the form of a colorless lacquer [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 0.97 (d, J=7 Hz, 6H), 1.88 (mt, 1H), 2.90 (s, 3H), 3.25 (t, J=7 Hz, 2H), 4.08 (mt, 2H), 4.36 (mt, 2H), 4.52 (s, 1H), 4.56 (broad t, J=7 Hz, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 10H)].
  • 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-hydroxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methylene]azetidine hydrochloride may be prepared in the following manner: 250 cm[0700] 3 of concentrated hydrochloric acid are added to a solution of 14 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-methoxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methylene]azetidine in 250 cm of acetic acid, at room temperature. The mixture is stirred for 38 hours at a temperature of 50° C. and is then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). Three times, the residue is supplemented with 250 cm3 of toluene and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa). After trituration of the residue in 400 cm3 of ethyl ether, 14.2 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-hydroxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methylene]azetidine hydrochloride are obtained in the form of a beige powder.
  • Example 121
  • 0.37 g of potassium tert-butoxide is added to a solution of 0.92 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one and 0.75 g of [(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]methylsulfone in 30 cm of tetrahydrofuran, under an argon atmosphere, cooled to −70° C., and the mixture is stirred for 2 hours at −70° C. 10 cm[0701] 3 of a 0.1 N solution of hydrochloric acid are then added and the mixture is allowed to return to room temperature. After addition of 50 cm3 of ethyl acetate, the reaction mixture is separated after settling out, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure
  • (2.7 pKa). The residue is chromatographed on a silica gel column (particle size 0.20-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 50 cm), eluting at a nitrogen pressure of 0.8 bar with a cyclohexane and ethyl acetate mixture (70/30 by volume) and collecting 120 cm[0702] 3 fractions. Fractions 11 to 18 are combined and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPA). The residue is crystallized from 10 cm3 of isopropyl ether and 30 cm3 of pentane. 0.30 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl(RS)]azetidin-3-ol is thus obtained in the form of a white solid [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.73 (s, 3H), 3.05 (AB, J=9 Hz, 2H), 3.27 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.63 (s, 1H), 3.79 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.95 (s, 3H), 4.32 (s, 1H), 4.59 (s, 1H), from 7.15 to 7.35 (mt, 8H), 7.51 (t, J=8 Hz, 1H), 7.94 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.10 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.32 (broad s, 1H))].
  • Example 122
  • By carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1, starting with 0.66 g of methyl(pyridin-4-ylmethyl)sulfone and 1.18 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one, 0.20 g of a white solid is obtained after purification on a silica gel column (particle size 0.20-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 50 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a cyclohexane and ethyl acetate mixture (70/30 by volume) as eluent and collecting 120 cm[0703] 3 fractions. The solid is taken up in 20 cm3 of diisopropyl ether. After filtration, draining and drying, 0.16 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(pyridin-4-yl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol is obtained [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.76 (s, 3H), 3.03 (AB, J=9 Hz, 2H), 3.27 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.53 (s, 1H), 3.83 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 4.32 (s, 1H), 4.51 (s, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.30 (mt, 8H), 7.63 (d, J=6 Hz, 2H), 8.68 (d, J=6 Hz, 2H)].
  • Methyl(pyridin-4-ylmethyl)sulfone may be prepared according to the reference JP43002711. [0704]
  • Example 123
  • By carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1, starting with 0.47 g of methyl(pyridin-3-ylmethyl)sulfone and 0.83 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one, 0.50 g of a white solid is obtained after purification on a silica gel column (particle size 0.20-0.06 mm, diameter 3 cm, height 50 cm), at a nitrogen pressure of 0.5 bar with a cyclohexane and ethyl 25 acetate mixture (70/30 by volume) as eluent and collecting 120 cm[0705] 3 fractions. The solid is taken up in 30 cm3 of diisopropyl ether. After filtration, draining and drying, 0.40 g of 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(pyridin-3yl)methyl-(RS)]-azetidin-3-ol is obtained [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.77 (s, 3H), 3.03 (AB, J=9 Hz, 2H), 3.28 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 3.66 (s, 1H), 3.83 (d, J=9 Hz, 1H), 4.33 (s, 1H), 4.55 (s, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.30 (mt, 8H), 7.37 (dd, J=8 and 5 Hz, 1H), 8.16 (dt, J=8 and 2 Hz, 1H), 8.68 (dd, J=5 and 1.5 Hz, 1H), δ 8.83 (d, J=2 Hz, 1H)].
  • Methyl(pyridin-3-ylmethyl)sulfone may be prepared according to the reference JP43002711. [0706]
  • Example 124
  • 0.0388 cm[0707] 3 of N-(3-aminopropyl)morpholine is added, at the same temperature, to a suspension of 150 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid activated on TFP resin (165 μM) in 3 cm3 of dichloromethane, pre-stirred for 90 minutes at a temperature close to 20° C. The suspension is stirred at a temperature close to 20° C. for 22 hours and then filtered on sintered glass. The solid residue is rewashed with twice 1.5 cm3 of dichloromethane. The filtrates are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 60 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-morpholin-4-ylpropyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a pale yellow foam.
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-morpholin-4-ylpropyl)benzamide may also be prepared in the following manner: 0.083 cm[0708] 3 of N-(3-aminopropyl)morpholine, 110 mg of 1-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-3-ethylcarbodiimide and 5 mg of 4-dimethylaminopyridine are successively added to a solution of 300 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid in 10 cm3 of anhydrous dichloromethane (over calcium chloride) and 5 cm3 of dimethylformamide, under an inert atmosphere of nitrogen, at a temperature close to 20° C. The solution obtained is stirred at a temperature close to 20° C. for about 22 hours and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (0.27 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. The solid residue is taken up in 25 cm3 of dichloromethane and washed with twice 20 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. After separation after settling out, the organic phase is dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (2.7 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 400 mg of a yellow oil are thus obtained, which oil is purified by chromatography under nitrogen pressure (0.8 bar) on 60 cm3 of silica (0.040-0.063 mm) contained in a column 2.2 cm in diameter, eluting with a methanol/dichloromethane mixture (2-98 by volume). The fractions containing only the desired product are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (0.27 kPa) at 40° C. for 2 hours. 130 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-morpholin-4-ylpropyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a white crystalline powder [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 1.68 (mt, 2H), from 2.25 to 2.40 (mt, 6H), 2.97 (s, 3H), from 3.20 to 3.35 (mt, 2H), 3.57 (t, J=4.5 Hz, 4H), 3.81 (mt, 2H), 4.22 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.83 (broad s, 1H), 7.86 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.53 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 125
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.033 cm[0709] 3 of N,N-dimethyl-1,3-propanediamine. 52 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a white powder [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 1.65 (mt, 2H), 2.18 (s, 6H), from 2.20 to 2.35 (mt, 2H), 2.98 (s, 3H), from 3.25 to 3.45 (mt, 2H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.80 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H),7.46 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.83 (broad s, 1H), 7.86 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.57 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 126
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.0333 cm[0710] 3 of 1-(aminoethyl)pyrrolidine. 39 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-pyrrolidin-1-ylethyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a pale yelow powder [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6 with addition of a few drops of CD3COOD-d4, □ in ppm): from 1.80 to 2.00 (mt, 4H), 2.97 (s, 3H), 3.20 (mt, 6H), 3.57 (t, J=6.5 Hz, 2H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.77 (s, 1H), 7.35 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), 7.45 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.65 (mt, 2H), 7.87 (broad s, 1H), 7.90 (broad d, J=7.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 127
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.0333 cm[0711] 3 of 1-(dimethylamino)-2-propylamine. 49 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-dimethylamino-1-methylethyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a white powder [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 1.13 (d, J=6.5 Hz, 3H), from 2.10 to 2.25 (mt, 1H), 2.15 (s, 6H), 2.38 (dd, J=13 and 8 Hz, 1H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.14 (mt, 1H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), from 7.45 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.83 (broad s, 1H), 7.87 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.16 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 128
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.026 cm[0712] 3 of piperidine. 56 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-piperidin-1-ylbenzamide are thus obtained in the form of a white powder [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): from 1.45 to 1.70 (mt, 6H), from 2.90 to 3.05 (mt, 2H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.19 (unresolved complex, 1H), 3.57 (unresolved complex, 1H), 3.85 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.80 (s, 1H), from 7.30 to 7.55 (mt, 12H)].
  • Example 129
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.0265 cm[0713] 3 of isobutylamine. 46 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-isobutylbenzamide are thus obtained in the form of a white powder [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 0.89 (d, J=7 Hz, 6H), 1.85 (mt, 1H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.09 (t, J=6.5 Hz, 2H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.84 (broad s, 1H), 7.88 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.51 (t, J=6 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 130
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.0316 cm[0714] 3 of N-(3-aminopropyl)imidazole. 54 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-imidazol-1-ylpropyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a yellow foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 1.97 (mt, 2H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.25 (mt, 2H), 3.81 (mt, 2H), 4.02 (t, J=7 Hz, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), from 6.85 to 6.95 (mt, 2H), 7.36 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.84 (broad s, 1H), 7.88 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.56 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 131
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.030 cm[0715] 3 of N,N-(dimethyl)ethylenediamine. 53 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-dimethylaminoethyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of an ochre-colored foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 2.18 (2s, 6H), from 2.35 to 2.45 (mt, 2H), 2.98 (s, 3H), from 3.25 to 3.50 (mt, 2H), 3.81 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), from 7.45 to 7.60 (mt, 2H) 7.83 (broad s, 1H), 7.86 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.43 (t, J=6.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 132
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.0141 cm[0716] 3 of methylhydrazine. 42 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid N′methylhydrazide are thus obtained in the form of a pale yellow foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 2.96 (s, 3H), 3.18 (broad s, 3H), 3.83 (mt, 2H), 4.22 (mt, 2H), 4.80 (broad s, 2H), from 7.35 to 7.65 (mt, 12H)].
  • Example 133
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.0345 cm[0717] 3 of N-(2-aminoethyl)morpholine. 62 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-morpholin-4-ylethyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of an ochre-colored foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): from 2.30 to 2.45 (mt, 4H), 2.46 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.38 (mt, 2H), from 3.50 to 3.65 (mt, 4H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 4.24 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.83 (broad s, 1H), 7.85 (dd, J=8 and 2 Hz, 1H), 8.45 (t, J=6.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 134
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 150 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (165 μM) and 0.0396 cm[0718] 3 of 2-(aminomethyl)-N-ethylpyrrolidine. 58 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(1-ethylpyrrolidin-2-ylmethyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of an ochre-colored foam.
  • 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(1-ethylpyrrolidin-2-ylmethyl)benzamide may also be prepared under the conditions described in Example 126 starting with 700 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (770 μM), 0.324 cm[0719] 3 of triethylamine and 0.25 cm3 of 2-(aminomethyl)-N-ethylpyrrolidine. 370 mg of a solid are thus obtained, which solid is purified by chromatography under nitrogen pressure (0.7 bar) on 100 cm3 of silica (0.040-0.063 mm) contained in a column 2.5 cm in diameter, eluting with a methanol-dichloromethane mixture (15-85 by volume). The fractions containing only the desired product are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (0.27 kPa) at 40° C. for 2 hours. 160 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(1-ethylpyrrolidin-2-ylmethyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a pale yellow powder [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 1.04 (t, J=7 Hz, 3H), from 1.50 to 1.70 (mt, 3H), 1.78 (mt, 1H), 2.14 (mt, 1H), 2.28 (mt, 1H), 2.59 (mt, 1H), 2.83 (mt, 1H), 2.98 (s, 3H), from 3.00 to 3.15 (mt, 2H), from 3.30 to 3.45 (mt, 1H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.86 (broad s, 1H), 7.85 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.41 (t, J=6 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 135
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 110 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (121 μM) and 0.023 cm[0720] 3 of neopentylamine. 69 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2,2-dimethylpropyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a pale yellow powder [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 0.90 (s, 9H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.11 (d, J=6.5 Hz, 2H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), from 7.45 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.83 (broad s, 1H), 7.86 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.37 (t, J=6.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 136
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 110 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (121 μM) and 0.025 cm[0721] 3 of aminomethylcyclohexane. 44 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-cyclohexylmethylbenzamide are thus obtained in the form of a pale yellow powder whose characteristics are the following [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 0.92 (mt, 2H), 1.17 (mt, 4H), from 1.45 to 1.80 (mt, 5H), 2.97 (s, 3H), 3.10 (d, J=6 Hz, 2H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), from 7.45 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.83 (broad s, 1H), 7.86 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.47 (t, J=6 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 137
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 110 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (121 μM), 0.026 cm[0722] 3 of triethylamine and 21 mg of aminomethylcyclopropane hydrochloride. 68 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-cyclopropylmethylbenzamide are thus obtained in the form of a yellow foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 0.24 (mt, 2H), 0.44 (mt, 2H), 1.03 (mt, 1H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.15 (t, J=6 Hz, 2H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.86 (broad s, 1H), 7.89 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.64 (t, J=6 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 138
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 110 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (121 μM) and 0.023 cm[0723] 3 of 2-methylbutylamine. 49 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-methylbutyl)benzamide are thus obtained [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): from 0.80 to 0.95 (mt, 6H), from 1.05 to 120 (mt, 1H), 1.41 (mt, 1H), 1.64 (mt, 1H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.06 (mt, 1H), 3.19 (mt, 1H), 3.81 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), from 7.35 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.84 (broad s, 1H), 7.87 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.49 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 139
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 110 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (121 μM) and 0.028 cm[0724] 3 of 2-methylphenethylamine. 42 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-phenylpropyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a yellow paste [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 1.24 (d, J=7 Hz, 3H), 2.97 (s, 3H), 3.07 (mt, 1H), from 3.20 to 3.50 (mt, 2H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.80 (s, 1H), from 7.10 to 7.40 (mt, 5H), 7.38 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.47 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.77 (broad s, 1H), 7.79 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.55 (t, J=6 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 140
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 110 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (121 μM) and 0.020 cm[0725] 3 of tetrahydrofurfurylmethylamine. 42 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(tetrahydrofuran-2-ylmethyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a yellow paste [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 1.58 (mt, 1H), from 1.75 to 2.00 (mt, 3H), 2.98 (s, 3H), from 3.20 to 3.40 (mt, 2H), 3.63 (mt, 1H), 3.77 (mt, 1H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 3.98 (mt, 1H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), from 7.50 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.84 (broad s, 1H), 7.88 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.60 (t, J=6 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 141
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 110 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (121 μM) and 39 mg of 2,2-diphenylethylamine. 39 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2;2-diphenylethyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a yellow paste [[0726] 1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 2.95 (s, 3H), 3.77 (mt, 2H), 3.90 (dd, J=8 and 6.5 Hz, 2H), 4.22 (mt, 2H), 4.42 (t, J=8 Hz, 1H), 4.79 (s, 1H), from 7.10 to 7.40 (mt, 10H), 7.38 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.45 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.48 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), 7.70 (mt, 2H), 8.56 (t, J=6.5 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 142
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 110 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (121 μM) and 19 mg of 2-ethylbutylamine. 47 mg of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-ethylbutyl)benzamide are thus obtained in the form of a pale yellow powder [[0727] 1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 0.86 (t, J=7 Hz, 6H), from 1.20 to 1.40 (mt, 4H), 1.50 (mt, 1H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.19 (t, J=6 Hz, 2H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 4.24 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 4H), from 7.45 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.83 (broad s, 1H), 7.86 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.42 (t, J=6 Hz, 1H)].
  • Example 143
  • The operation is carried out under the conditions described in Example 124 starting with 110 mg of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin (121 μM), 0.026 cm[0728] 3 of triethylamine and 39 mg of 4-aminomethylcyclohexanecarboxylic acid methyl ester hydrochloride. 47 mg of 4-{[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoylamino]methyl}cyclohexanecarboxylic acid methyl ester are thus obtained in the form of a pale yellow paste [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): from 0.90 to 1.05 (mt, 2H), from 1.20 to 1.40 (mt, 2H), 1.52 (mt, 1H), from 1.70 to 2.00 (mt, 4H), 2.27 (mt, 1H), 2.98 (s, 3H), 3.12 (t, J=6.5 Hz, 2H), 3.60 (s, 3H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.23 (mt, 2H), 4.79 (s, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), from 7.45 to 7.60 (mt, 2H), 7.83 (broad s, 1H), 7.87 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 8.50 (t, J=6 Hz, 1H)].
  • Activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin may be prepared under the following conditions: 1.18 g of 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid is added, at the same temperature, to a suspension of 1.07 g of TFP resin (free phenol function, 1.1 mmol/g, that is to say 1.17 mM) in 15 cm[0729] 3 of anhydrous dimethylformamide, prestirred for 10 minutes at a temperature close to 20° C. After stirring for 10 minutes at a temperature close to 20° C., 14 mg of 4-dimethylaminopyridine are added and then after stirring for 10 minutes at the same temperature, 0.185 cm3 of 1,3-diisopropylcarbodiimide. After stirring for 23 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., the suspension is filtered and the resin is washed with 45 cm3 of dimethylformamide, 45 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran, 45 cm3 of dichloromethane, and then dried under vacuum to constant weight. 1.5 g of activated 3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid on TFP resin are thus obtained in the form of a pale yellow resin.
  • The TFP resin (structure below) may be prepared in the following manner: [0730]
    Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00012
  • 492 mg of diisopropylcarbodiimide, 819.3 mg of 2,3,5,6-tetrafluoro-4-hydroxybenzoic acid and 50 mg of 4-dimethylaminopyridine are successively added to a suspension of 2 g of commercially available aminomethyl polystyrene resin (0.39 mmol/g; 0.78 mmol) in 15 cm[0731] 3 of dimethylformamide, prestirred for 5 minutes at a temperature close to 20° C. After stirring for about 20 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., the suspension is filtered and the resin is rinsed with three times 20 cm3 of dimethylformamide, three times 20 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran and three times 20 cm3 of dichloromethane. The resin obtained is dried under reduced pressure at a temperature close to 40° C. The resin obtained is then stirred, at a temperature close to 20° C., for about 20 hours, in suspension in a piperidine/dimethylformamide mixture (10/90 by volume). The suspension is filtered and the resin is rinsed with three times 20 cm3 of dimethylformamide, three times 20 cm3 of tetrahydrofuran and three times 20 cm3 of dichloromethane. The resin obtained is dried under reduced pressure at a temperature close to 40° C. and is used as it is.
  • Example 144
  • A solution of 76 mg of (2-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-oxoethyl)carbamic acid tert-butyl ester in 2.5 cm[0732] 3 of formic acid is stirred for 1 hour at a temperature close to 45° C. The reaction medium is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (5 kPa) at a temperature close to 30° C., taken up in 10 cm3 of ethyl acetate and alkalinized with 10 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. After separating after settling out, the organic phase is washed with 10 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 51 mg of 2-amino-1-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}ethanone are thus obtained in the form of a beige lacquer [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): from 1.95 to 2.25 (broad unresolved complex, 2H), 2.77 (s, 3H), from 3.10 to 3.30 (mt, 4H), from 3.50 to 3.60 (mt, 2H), 3.56 (broad s, 2H), from 3.75 to 3.90 (mt, 4H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.91 (dd, J=8 and 2 Hz, 1H), 7.01 (mt, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 9H)].
  • Example 145
  • 1.02 g of supported EDCI (5 mM), 44 mg of N-Boc-glycine and then 10 cm[0733] 3 of dichloromethane are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to 108.5 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine. After stirring for 20 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., the reaction mixture is filtered on sintered glass. The resin is rinsed with three times 5 cm3 of dichloromethane. The combined filtrates are washed with 20 cm of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered on sintered glass and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 143 mg of (2-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-oxoethyl)carbamic acid tert-butyl ester are thus obtained in the form of a cream-colored lacquer [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 1.40 (s, 9H), 2.93 (s, 3H), from 3.05 to (mt, 4H), 3.57 (mt, 4H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 3.84 (d, J=6 Hz, 2H), 4.19 (mt, 2H), 4.78 (s, 1H), 6.79 (t, J=6 Hz, 1H), 6.82 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.93 (broad s, 1H), 6.99 (dd, J=8 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.27 (t, J=8 Hz, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H)].
  • The supported EDCI reagent is commercially available and may also be prepared according to the following reference: M. Desai, L. Stramiello, [0734] Tetrahedron Letters, 34, 48, 7685-7688 (1993).
  • Example 146
  • A solution of 81 mg of (2-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-oxoethyl)-N-methylcarbamic acid tert-butyl ester in 2.5 cm[0735] 3 of formic acid is stirred for 1 hour at a temperature close to 45° C. The reaction mixture is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (5 kPa) at a temperature close to 30° C., taken up in 10 cm3 of ethyl acetate and alkalinized with 10 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. After separating after settling out, the organic phase is washed with 10 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 58 mg of 1-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-methylaminoethanone are thus obtained in the form of a beige lacquer [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3), □ in ppm): from 1.95 to 2.15 (broad unresolved complex, 1H), 2.51 (broad s, 3H), 2.77 (s, 3H), from 3.10 to 3.30 (mt, 4H), 3.49 (broad s, 2H), 3.58 (mt, 2H), from 3.75 to 3.90 (mt, 4H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.83 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8 and 2 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (mt, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 9H)].
  • Example 147
  • 1.02 g of supported EDCI (5 mM), 47.3 mg of N-Boc-sarcosine and 3 then 10 cm of dichloromethane are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to 108.5 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine. After stirring for 20 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., the reaction mixture is filtered on sintered glass. The resin is rinsed with three times 5 cm[0736] 3 of dichloromethane. The combined filtrates are washed with 20 cm of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered on sintered glass and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 143 mg of (2-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-oxoethyl)-N-methylcarbamic acid tert-butyl ester are thus obtained in the form of a cream-colored lacquer [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm). A mixture of rotamers is observed at room temperature; 1.31 and 1.41 (2s, 9H in total), 2.78 and 2.81 (2s, 3H in total), 2.93 (2s, 3H), from 3.10 to 3.25 (unresolved complex, 4H), from 3.45 to 3.65 (mt, 4H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.06 and 4.09 (2s, 2H in total), 4.19 (mt, 2H), 4.78 (s, 1H), 6.83 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.93 (broad s, 1H), 7.00 (dd, J=8 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.27 (t, J=8 Hz, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H)].
  • Example 148
  • 2 cm[0737] 3 of dichloromethane and then 11 mg of methyl isothiocyanate are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to 54.25 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-phenyl]piperazine. After stirring for 6 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., 0.05 cm3 of water is added to the reaction mixture. After stirring for 15 minutes at the same temperature, the reaction medium is dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 61 mg of 4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carbothioic acid N-methylamide are thus obtained in the form of a beige lacquer [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3), □ in ppm): 2.77 (s, 3H), 3.20 (d, J=5 Hz, 3H), 3.32 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 3.81 (mt, 2H), 4.00 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 5.63 (broad q, J=5 Hz, 1H), 6.80 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.85 (dd, J=8 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.94 (broad s, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.30 (mt, 5H), 7.32 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H)].
  • Example 149
  • 2 cm[0738] 3 of dichloromethane and then 11.5 mg of methyl isocyanate are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to 54.25 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-phenyl]piperazine. After stirring for 4 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., 0.05 cm3 of water is added to the mixture. After stirring for 15 minutes at the same temperature, the reaction medium is dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered on paper and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 66 mg of 4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid N-methylamide are thus obtained in the form of a beige lacquer [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3), □ in ppm): 2.75 (s, 3H), 2.85 (d, J=5 Hz, 3H), 3.19 (broad t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 3.52 (broad t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.45 (broad q, J=5 Hz, 1H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.81 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.89 (dd, J=8 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (broad s, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.30 (mt, 5H), 7.32 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H)].
  • Example 150
  • 2 cm[0739] 3 of pyridine and then 10.4 mg of methyl chloroformate are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to 54.25 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-phenyl]piperazine. After stirring for 6 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., the reaction medium is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (5 kPa) at a temperature close to 30° C. The residue obtained is taken up in 5 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 5 cm3 of water. After separating after settling out, the organic phase is washed with 2 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 62 mg of 4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid methyl ester are thus obtained in the form of a beige lacquer [1H NM spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3), □ in ppm): 2.75 (s, 3H), 3.15 (broad t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 3.62 (mt, 4H), 3.74 (s, 3H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.32 (mt, 2H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.81 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (broad s, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 9H)].
  • Example 151
  • 32 mg of sodium acetoxyborohydride and then 22 mg of isobutyraldehyde are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to a solution of 54.25 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine in 2 cm[0740] 3 of 1,2-dichloroethane. After stirring for 4 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., 3 cm3 of dichloromethane and 2 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution are added to the reaction medium. After separating after settling out, the organic [lacuna] is dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 63 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]-4-isobutylpiperazine are thus obtained in the form of a beige lacquer [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3), □ in ppm): 0.92 (d, J=7 Hz, 6H), 1.82 (mt, 1H), 2.14 (d, J=8 Hz, 2H), 2.54 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 2.75 (s, 3H), 3.18 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 4H), 3.81 (mt, 2H), 4.32 (mt, 2H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.78 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.89 (dd, J=8 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.97 (broad s, 1H), from 7.15 to 7.30 (mt, 5H), 7.32 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H)].
  • Example 152
  • 32 mg of sodium acetoxyborohydride and then 13 mg of acetaldehyde are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to a solution of 54 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine in 2 cm[0741] 3 of 1,2-dichloroethane. After stirring for 21 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., 2 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution are added to the reaction medium. After separating after settling out, the aqueous phase is reextracted with 2 cm3 of dichloromethane. The pooled organic phases are dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 20° C. 60 mg of a solid residue are thus obtained, which residue is taken up in 2 cm3 of methanol and 0.5 cm3 of dichloromethane. The solution obtained is deposited on a silica catridge (500 mg of SCX phase). The cartridge is washed with 5 cm3 of methanol and then the expected product is eluted with 5 cm3 of ammoniacal methanol (2 N) and then with an additional 5 cm3 of methanol. The filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 30° C. 42 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)-phenyl]-4-ethylpiperazine are thus obtained in the form of a colorless lacquer [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3), □ in ppm): 1.14 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 3H), 2.48 (q, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 2.60 (broad t, J=5 Hz, 4H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 3.22 (broad t, J=5 Hz, 4H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.79 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.91 (dd, J=8 and 2 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 9H)].
  • Example 153
  • 2 cm[0742] 3 of pyridine and then 11.5 mg of acetic anhydride are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to 54 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-phenyl]piperazine. After stirring for 23 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., the reaction medium is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 30° C. The residue obtained is taken up in 5 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 2 cm3 of water. After separating after settling out, the organic phase is washed with 2 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 52 mg of 4-acetyl 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine are thus obtained in the form of a beige foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3), □ in ppm): 2.16 (s, 3H), 2.77 (s, 3H), from 3.10 to 3.25 (mt, 4H), 3.63 (broad t, J=5.5 Hz, 2H), 3.78 (broad t, J=5.5 Hz, 2H), 3.82 (mt, 2H), 4.34 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.84 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.92 (dd, J=8 and 2 Hz, 1H), 7.02 (mt, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 9H)].
  • Example 154
  • 511 mg of supported EDCI (2.5 mM), 11.5 mg of N,N-dimethylglycine and then 5 cm[0743] 3 of dichloromethane are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to 54 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine. After stirring for 24 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., 35 mg of N,N-dimethylglycine are added. After stirring for 96 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., the reaction mixture is filtered on sintered glass. The resin is rinsed with three times 2.5 cm3 of dichloromethane. The combined filtrates are washed with 10 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (5 kPa) at a temperature close to 20° C. 53 mg of 1-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-dimethylaminoethanone are thus obtained in the form of a beige foam [H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 2.20 (s, 6H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.12 (s, 2H), 3.16 (mt, 4H), 3.58 (mt, 2H), 3.68 (mt, 2H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.19 (mt, 2H), 4.78 (s, 1H), 6.81 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.93 (broad s, 1H), 6.99 (dd, J=8 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.26 (t, J=8 Hz, 1H), 7.36 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.46 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H)].
  • Example 155
  • A solution of 320 mg of 4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester in 5 cm[0744] 3 of formic acid is stirred for 5 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., and then for 1 hour at a temperature close to 45° C. The reaction medium is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (5 kPa) at a temperature close to 30° C., taken up in 20 cm3 of ethyl acetate and alkalinized with 10 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium bicarbonate solution. After separating after settling out, the organic phase is washed with three times 10 cm3 of water, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. The residue obtained is purified by depositing, in solution in a minimum of dichloromethane, on silica gel deposited on a plate [(gel 0.5 mm thick, 5 plates of 20 □ 20 cm, eluent: dichloromethane-methanol (80-20 by volume)]. The zone corresponding to the adsorbed desired product, located with UV rays, is scraped and the silica recovered is washed on sintered glass with a dichloromethane-methanol mixture (75-25 by volume). The filtrates are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 30° C. 180 mg of 1-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine are thus obtained in the form of a white powder [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.77 (s, 3H), 3.05 (mt, 4H), 3.16 (mt, 4H), 3.81 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.79 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 9H)].
  • 4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 4 starting with 1.32 g of 4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)-methyl]-3-hydroxyazetidin-3-yl}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine 1-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester, 0.232 cm[0745] 3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.733 g of 4-dimethylaminopyridine, the residue obtained is purified by chromatography on a silica gel column (particle size 0.063-0.200 mm, diameter 2 cm, height 25 cm) at atmospheric pressure with a dichloromethane-methanol mixture (99.5-0.5 by volume) as eluent and collecting 15 cm3 fractions. The fractions containing the desired product are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (5 kPa) at a temperature close to 30° C. 0.86 g of 4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)-phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester is thus obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 1.50 (s, 9H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 3.14 (t, J=5 Hz, 4H), 3.57 (t, J=5 Hz, 4H), 3.81 (mt, 2H), 4.34 (mt, 2H) 4.49 (s, 1H), 6.81 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.90 (dd, J=8 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (broad s, 1H), from 7.20 to 7.30 (mt, 5H), 7.32 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H)]. 4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-hydroxyazetidin-3-yl}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 1 starting with 0.886 g of 4-(3-methanesulfonylmethylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester, 0.765 g of 1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one and 1.72 cm3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 1.37 g of 4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-hydroxyazetidin-3-yl} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester are obtained in the form of a beige powder.
  • 4-(3-Methanesulfonylmethylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 10 starting with 1.55 g of 4-(3—chloromethylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester and 0.766 g of sodium methanesulfinate, 0.9 g of 4-(3-methanesulfonylmethylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester is obtained in the form of a beige powder. [0746]
  • 4-(3-Chloromethylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester may be prepared in the following manner: by reacting 16.4 g of 4-(3-hydroxymethylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester in 150 cm[0747] 3 of dichloromethane, at a temperature close to 20° C., with 29 cm3 of diisopropylethylamine and 8.7 cm3 of methanesulfonyl chloride, 15 g of 4-(3-chloromethylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester are obtained in the form of a beige powder after purification on a chromatographic column (silica 0.063-0.200 mm, diameter 6 cm, height 45 cm, 100 cm3 fractions), eluting with dichloromethane.
  • 4-(3-Hydroxymethylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester may be prepared in the following manner: by reacting 15.8 g of tert-butyl esters of 4-(3-butoxycarbonylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic and 4-(3-n-butyloxycarbonylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acids in solution in 500 cm[0748] 3 of anhydrous THF, at a temperature close to −10C, with 102 cm3 of diisobutylaluminum hydride in solution in toluene (20% by weight), 12.8 g of 4-(3-hydroxymethylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester are obtained in the form of a beige oil.
  • The mixture of tert-butyl esters of 4-(3-ethoxycarbonylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic and 4-(3-n-butyloxycarbonylphenyl)piperazine-1-carboxylic acids may be prepared according to the method described in patent WO 9726250. [0749]
  • Example 156
  • On carrying out the operation according to Example 38 (method 2) starting with 0.3 g of 3-acetoxy-1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl(RS)]azetidine and 105 mg of lithium hydroxide monohydrate in 10 cm[0750] 3 of acetonitrile, at a temperature close to 70° C., 0.24 g of 1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine is obtained in the form of an orange-colored foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.81 (s, 3H), from 3.85 to 3.95 (mt, 2H), 3.89 (s, 6H), 4.37 (mt, 2H), 4.67 (s, 1H), 6.84 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (mt, 2H), 7.50 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H), 7.97 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H)].
  • Example 157
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 40 starting with 4.45 g of (3,5-difluorobenzyl)methylsulfone, 6.36 g of 1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one, 2.18 cm[0751] 3
  • of acetyl chloride and 17 cm[0752] 3 of a 1.6 M solution of n-butyllithium in hexane, 10.8 g of 3-acetoxy-1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methyl(RS)]azetidine are obtained in the form of a pale yellow foam [1H NMR spectrum
  • (400 MHz, (CD[0753] 3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 2.03 (s, 3H), 2.96 (s, 3H), from 3.25 to 3.40 (mt, 2H), 3.52 (broad d, J=8 Hz, 1H), from 3.75 to 3.90 (mt, 1H), 3.82 (s, 3H), 3.83 (s, 3H), 4.72 (s, 1H), 5.36 (s, 1H), 7.27 (d, J=8 Hz, 2H), from 7.35 to 7.45 (mt, 2H), 7.43 (d, J=8 Hz, 2H), 7.54 (tt, J=9.5 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 7.81 (d, J=8 Hz, 2H), 7.88 (d, J=8 Hz, 2H)].
  • 1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-one may be prepared in the same manner as 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-one (Example 110) from 1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ol. [0754]
  • 1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ol, may be prepared in the same manner as 1-{(R*)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(methoxycarbonyl)phenyl]methyl}azetidin-3-ol (Example 110) from bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methylamine. [0755]
  • Bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methylamine may be prepared in the same manner as methyl 4-[(RS)-amino-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]benzoate (Example 87) from 4,4′-dimethoxycarbonylbenzophenone. [0756]
  • Example 158
  • On carrying out the operation according to the procedure of Example 110 starting with 40 mg of (RS)-1-{[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methyl)methylsulfonylmethylene]azetidine, 0.25 cm[0757] 3 of dichloromethane and 0.0196 cm3 of morpholine, 35.8 mg of (RS)-4-[4-((4-chlorophenyl){3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)methanesulfonylmethylene]azetidin-1-yl}methyl)benzyl]morpholine are obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 2.41 (mt, 4H), 2.80 (s, 3H), 3.42 (s, 2H), 3.69 (t, J=4.5 Hz, 4H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 4.33 (mt, 2H), 4.50 (s, 1H), 6.83 (tt, J=9 and 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.98 (mt, 2H), from 7.20 to 7.40 (mt, 8H)].
  • (RS)-1-{[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl](4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)methylsulfonylmethylene]azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: on carrying out the operation according to Example 87 starting with 415 mg of (RS)-1-{(4-(chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, 5 cm[0758] 3 of dichloromethane, 0.19 cm3 of methanesulfonyl chloride and 0.53 cm3 of diisopropylethylamine, 421.2 mg of (RS)-1-{[4-(chloromethyl)phenyl] (4-chlorophenyl)methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl)methylsulfonylmethylene]azetidine are obtained in the form of a cream-colored foam.
  • Example 159
  • 25 mg of potassium carbonate and then 0.016 cm[0759] 3 of morpholine are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., under an inert atmosphere of argon, to a solution of 33 mg of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(4-bromobutoxy)phenyl]methanesulfonylmethylene}azetidine in 2 cm3 of anhydrous acetonitrile. After stirring for 17 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., the reaction medium is diluted with 10 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 4 cm3 of water. The separated organic phase is washed with 4 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered on sintered glass and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. The residue obtained is purified by depositing, in solution in a minimum of dichloromethane, on chromatography on silica gel deposited on a plate [(gel 0.5 mm thick, 2 plates of 20 □ 20 cm, eluent: dichloromethane-methanol (92.5-7.5 by volume)]. The zone corresponding to the desired product adsorbed, located with UV rays, is scraped and the silica recovered is washed on sintered glass with a dichloromethane-methanol mixture (80-20 by volume). The filtrates are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 25.2 mg of 4-(4-{3-[(1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-ylidene)methanesulfonylmethyl]phenoxy}butyl)morpholine are obtained in the form of a pale yellow foam [1H NMR spectrum (400 MHz, CDCl3, □ in ppm): 1.66 (mt, 2H), 1.81 (mt, 2H), 2.40 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 2.46 (mt, 4H), 2.77 (s, 3H), 3.72 (t, J=5 Hz, 4H), 3.84 (mt, 2H), 3.96 (t, J=6.5 Hz, 2H), 4.36 (mt, 2H), 4.53 (s, 1H), 6.87 (dd, J=8 and 2 Hz, 1H), 6.93 (d, J=8 Hz, 1H), 6.96 (d, J=2 Hz, 1H), from 7.10 to 7.35 (mt, 7H), 7.42 (d, J=8 Hz, 4H)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-{[3-(4-bromobutoxy)phenyl]methanesulfonylmethylene}azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 0.586 cm[0760] 3 of 1,4-dibromobutane and 255 mg of potassium carbonate are successively added at a temperature close to 20° C., under an inert atmosphere of argon, to a solution of 500 mg of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-hydroxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 10 cm3 of methylethyl ketone. The reaction mixture is heated at the reflux temperature of the solvent, under an inert atomosphere of argon, for 7 hours and then left at a temperature close to 20° C. for about 4 days. The reaction mixtue is filtered on sintered glass covered with celite. The solid residue is rinsed with ethyl acetate and then the filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (10 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. The brown oil obtained is purified by chromatography at atmospheric pressure on 40 g of silica (0.063-0.200 mm) contained in a column 3 cm in diameter, eluting with a methanol-dichloromethane mixture (0.5-99.5 by volume). The fractions (10 cm3) containing only the desired product are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (0.27 kPa) at 40° C. for 2 hours, 408.4 mg of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(4-bromobutoxy)phenyl]methanesulfonylmethylene}azetidine are thus obtained in the form of a brown foam.
  • Example 160
  • 0.110 cm[0761] 3 of morpholine and then 35 mg of potassium carbonate are successively added, at a temperature close to 20° C., to a solution of 45 mg of 1-benzhydryl-3-{[3-(4-bromopropyloxy)phenyl]methanesulfonylmethylene}azetidine in 3.5 cm3 of anhydrous acetonitrile. After stirring for 20 hours at a temperature close to 20° C., the reaction medium is diluted with 40 cm3 of ethyl acetate and 10 cm3 of water. The separated organic phase is washed with 10 cm3 of water, and then twice 10 cm3 of a saturated aqueous sodium chloride solution, dried over magnesium sulfate, filtered on sintered glass and then concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (9 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. The yellow lacquer obtained is purified by depositing, in solution in a minimum of dichloromethane, on chromatography on silica gel deposited on a plate [(gel 0.5 mm thick, 2 plates of 20 □ 20 cm, eluent: dichloromethanemethanol (97.5-2.5 by volume)]. The zone corresponding to the desired product adsorbed, located with UV rays, is scraped and the silica recovered is washed on sintered glass with a dichloromethane-methanol mixture (85-15 by volume). The filtrates are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (1 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. 33 mg of 4-(4-{3-[(1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-ylidene)methanesulfonylmethyl]phenoxy}propyl)morpholine are thus obtained in the form of a white foam [1H NMR spectrum (300 MHz, (CD3)2SO-d6, □ in ppm): 1.87 (mt, 2H), 2.37 (mt, 4H), 2.42 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 2.94 (s, 3H), 3.58 (mt, 4H), 3.80 (mt, 2H), 4.02 (t, J=7 Hz, 2H), 4.20 (mt, 2H), 4.74 (s, 1H), 6.97 (mt, 3H), 7.22 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), from 7.25 to 7.40 (mt, 1H), 7.32 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 4H), 7.48 (d, J=7.5 Hz, 4H)].
  • 1-Benzhydryl-3-{[3-(4-bromopropyloxy)phenyl]methanesulfonylmethylene}azetidine may be prepared in the following manner: 0.5 cm of 1,3-dibromopropane and 255 mg of potassium carbonate are successively added at a temperature close to 20° C., under an inert atmosphere of argon, to a solution of 500 mg of 1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-hydroxyphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine in 10 cm[0762] 3 of methyl ethyl ketone. The reaction mixture is heated at the reflux temperature of the solvent, under an inert atmosphere of argon, for 7 hours, and then left at a temperature close to 20° C. for about 4 days. The reaction mixture is filtered on sintered glass covered with celite. The solid residue is rinsed with ethyl acetate and then the filtrate is concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (10 kPa) at a temperature close to 40° C. The brown oil obtained is purified by chromatography at atmospheric pressure on 40 g of silica (0.063-0.200 mm) contained in a column 3 cm in diameter, eluting with a methanol-dichloromethane mixture (0.5-99.5 by volume). The fractions (10 cm3) containing only the desired product are combined and concentrated to dryness under reduced pressure (0.27 kPa) at 40° C. for 2 hours. 511.1 mg of benzhydryl-3-{[3-(4-bromopropyloxy)-phenyl]methanesulfonylmethylene}azetidine are thus obtained in the form of a brown foam.
  • The medicaments according to the invention consists of a compound of formula (I) or an isomer or a salt of such a compound, in the pure state or in the form of a composition in which it is combined with any other pharmaceutically compatible product which may be inert or physiologically active. The medicaments according to the invention may be used orally, parenterally, rectally or topically. [0763]
  • As solid compositions for oral administration, tablets, pills, powders (gelatine capsules, sachets) or granules may be used. In these compositions, the active ingredient according to the invention is mixed with one or more inert diluents, such as starch, cellulose, sucrose, lactose or silica, under an argon stream. These compositions may also comprise substances other than diluents, for example one or more lubricants such as magnesium stearate or talc, a coloring, a coating (sugar-coated tablet) or a glaze. [0764]
  • As liquid compositions for oral administration, there may be used pharmaceutically acceptable solutions, suspensions, emulsions, syrups and elixirs containing inert diluents such as water, ethanol, glycerol, vegetable oils or paraffin oil. These compositions may comprise substances other than diluents, for example wetting, sweetening, thickening, flavoring or stabilizing products. [0765]
  • Sterile compositions for parenteral administration may be preferably solutions which are aqueous or nonaqueous, suspensions or emulsions. As solvent or vehicle, there may be used water, propylene glycol, polyethylene glycol, vegetable oils, in particular olive oil, injectable organic esters, for example ethyl oleate or other suitable organic solvents. These compositions may also contain adjuvants, in particular wetting, isotonizing, emulsifying, dispersing and stabilizing agents. Sterilization may be carried out in several ways, for example by aseptisizing filtration, by incorporating sterilizing agents into the composition, by irradiation or by heating. They may also be prepared in the form of sterile solid compositions which may be dissolved at the time of use in sterile water or any other injectable sterile medium. [0766]
  • Compositions for rectal administration are suppositories or rectal capsules which contain, in addition to the active product, excipients such as cocoa butter, semisynthetic glycerides or polyethylene glycols. [0767]
  • Compositions for topical administration may be, for example, creams, lotions, collyria, collutoria, nasal drops or aerosols. [0768]
  • In human therapy, the compounds according to the invention are particularly useful for the treatment and/or prevention of psychoses including schizophrenia, anxiety disorders, depression, epilepsy, neurodegeneration, cerebellar and spinocerebellar disorders, cognitive disorders, cranial trauma, panic attacks, peripheral neuropathies, glaucomas, migraine, Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease, Huntington's chorea, Raynaud's syndrome, tremor, obsessive-compulsive disorder, senile dementia, thymic disorders, Tourette's syndrome, tardive dyskinesia, bipolar disorders, cancers, movement disorders induced by medicaments, dystonia, endotoxemic shocks, hemorrhagic shocks, hypotension, insomnia, immunological diseases, multiple sclerosis, vomiting, asthma, appetite disorders (bulimia, anorexia), obesity, memory disorders, intestinal transit disorders, in weaning from chronic treatments and alcohol or drug abuse (opiods, barbiturates, cannabis, cocaine, amphetamine, phencyclide, hallucinogens, benzodiazepines for example), as analgesics or potentiators of the analgesic activity of the narcotic and nonnarcotic drugs as antibacterial, antiviral and antiparasitic agents. [0769]
  • The doses depend on the desired effect, the duration of the treatment and the route of administration used; they are generally between 5 mg and 1000 mg per day orally for an adult with unit doses ranging from 1 mg to 250 mg of active substance. [0770]
  • In general, the doctor will determine the appropriate dosage depending on the age, weight and any other factors specific to the subject to be treated. [0771]
  • The following examples illustrate the compositions according to the invention: [0772]
  • EXAMPLE A
  • Gelatin capsules containing a dose of 50 mg of active product and having the following composition are prepared according to the usual technique: [0773]
    Compound of formula (I) 50 mg
    Cellulose 18 mg
    Lactose 55 mg
    Colloidal silica  1 mg
    Sodium carboxymethylstarch 10 mg
    Talc 10 mg
    Magnesium stearate  1 mg
  • EXAMPLE B
  • Tablets containing a dose of 50 mg of active product and having the following composition are prepared according to the usual technique: [0774]
    Compound of formula (I)  50 mg
    Lactose 104 mg
    Cellulose  40 mg
    Polyvidone  10 mg
    Sodium carboxymethylstarch  22 mg
    Talc  10 mg
    Magnesium stearate  2 mg
    Colloidal silica  2 mg
  • EXAMPLE C
  • An injectable solution containing 10 mg of active product and having the following composition is prepared: [0775]
    Compound of formula (I) 10 mg
    Benzoic acid 80 mg
    Benzyl alcohol 0.06 ml
    Sodium benzoate 80 mg
    Ethanol, 95% 0.4 ml
    Sodium hydroxide 24 mg
    Propylene glycol 1.6 ml
    Water qs 4 ml

Claims (17)

1. A method of treating a condition selected from the group consisting of schizophrenia, Parkinson's disease, and Alzeimer's disease, this method comprising administering to a patient in need of such treatment an effective amount to treat said condition of a compound of formula:
Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00013
in which
R represents
Figure US20040235816A1-20041125-C00014
R1 represents a methyl or ethyl radical;
R2 represents either an aromatic radical selected from phenyl, naphthyl and indenyl, these aromatic radicals being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more substituents selected from halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, —CO-alk, hydroxyl, —COOR5, formyl, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethylsulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, nitro, —NR6R7, —CO—NH—NR6R7, —N(alk)COOR8, cyano, —CONHR9, —CO—NR16R1 7, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, —O-alk-NR12R13 and alkylthioalkyl or a heteroaromatic radical selected from benzofuryl, benzothiazolyl, benzothienyl, benzoxazolyl, chromanyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuryl, 2,3-dihydrobenzothienyl, indolinyl, indolyl, isochromanyl, isoquinolyl, pyridyl, quinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolyl, thiazolyl, and thienyl, these heteroaromatic radicals being nonsubstituted or substituted with a substituent selected from halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, —COOR5, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethylsulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, nitro, —NR6R7, —CO—NH—NR6R7, cyano, —CONHR9, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl and alkylthioalkyl;
R3 and R4, which are identical or different, each represent either an aromatic radical selected from phenyl, naphthyl and indenyl, these aromatic radicals being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more substituents selected from halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, formyl, hydroxyl, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, —CO-alk, cyano, —COOR5, —CONR10R11, —CO—NH—NR6R7, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-NR6R7 and alkylthioalkyl; or a heteroaromatic radical selected from benzofuryl, benzothiazolyl, benzothienyl, benzoxazolyl, chromanyl, 2,3-dihydrobenzofuryl, 2,3-dihydrobenzothienyl, furyl, isochromanyl, isoquinolyl, pyrrolyl, quinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolyl, thiazolyl and thienyl, these heteroaromatics being nonsubstituted or substituted with a substituent selected from halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyl, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, cyano, —COOR5, —CO—NH—NR6R7, —CONR10R11, -alk-NR6R7, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl and alkylthioalkyl;
R5 is an alkyl or phenyl radical which is optionally substituted with one or more halogens;
R6 and R7, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen, alkyl, —COOalk, cycloalkyl, alkylcycloalkyl, -alk-O-alk or hydroxyalkyl radical or, alternatively, R6 and R7 together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk, —CO-alk-NR14R15, oxo, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-O-alk or —CO—NH2 radicals; R8 represents an alkyl radical;
R9 represents a hydrogen or unsubstituted alkyl radical or an alkyl radical that is substituted with a dialkylamino, phenyl, cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with —COalk) or a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing one or more heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl radicals;
R10 and R, 1, which are identical or different, each represent a hydrogen atom or an alkyl radical or, alternatively, R10 and R11, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and are optionally substituted with an alkyl radical;
R12 and R13, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen, alkyl or cycloalkyl radical or, alternatively, R12 and R13, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 radical, or a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing a heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
R14 and R15, which are identical or different, represent a hydrogen, alkyl or —COOalk radical;
R16 and R17, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3-to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
R′ represents a hydrogen or —CO-alk radical;
alk represents an alkyl or alkylene radical, it being understood that the alkyl and alkylene radicals and portions and the alkoxy radicals and portions are in the form of a straight or branched chain and contain 1 to 6 carbon atoms,
or an optical isomer thereof or a salt thereof with an inorganic or organic acid.
2. The method of claim 1 wherein, in the compound of formula (I) according to claim 1, when R6 and R7, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, the latter is an azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidyl, morpholinyl, imidazolyl, thiomorpholinyl or furyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with an alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-O-alk, —CONH2, —COalk, —COOalk, oxo, —CSNHalk, —CONHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 in which alk, R14 and R15 have the same meanings as in claim 1, or an optical isomer thereof or a salt thereof with an inorganic or organic acid.
3. The method of claim 1 wherein, in the compound of formula (I) according to claim 1, when R10 and R11, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, said heterocycle is an azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidyl, morpholinyl or thiomorpholinyl ring, these rings being optionally substituted with an alkyl.
4. The method of claim 1 wherein, in the compound of formula (I) according to claim 1, when R12 and R13, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, said heterocycle is selected from azetidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, piperazinyl, piperidyl, morpholinyl and thiomorpholinyl rings, these rings being optionally substituted with an alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 radical or a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing a heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen, alk, R14 and R1 5 having the same meanings as in claim 1, an optical isomer thereof, or a salt thereof with an inorganic or organic acid.
5. The method of claim 4 wherein said heterocycle is a thiomorpholinyl radical.
6. The method of claim 1 wherein, in the compound of formula (I) according to claim 1, when R16 and R17, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle, said heterocycle is a piperidyl ring, or an optical isomer thereof or a salt thereof with an inorganic or organic acid.
7. The method of claim 1 wherein, in the compound of formula (I) according to claim 1, R9 is an alkyl radical substituted with a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle selected from pyrrolidinyl, tetrahydrofuryl, morpholinyl and pyrrolyl rings, these rings being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl radicals, an optical isomer thereof or a salt thereof with an inorganic or organic acid.
8. The method of claim 1 wherein, in the compound of formula (I) according to claim 1,
R represents structure (A) or (B);
R′ represents a hydrogen atom or a —COalk radical;
R1 represents a methyl or ethyl radical;
R2 represents either an aromatic radical selected from phenyl and naphthyl, these aromatic radicals being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more substituents selected from halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyl, —COOR5, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethylsulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, —NR6R7, —CO—NH—NR6R7, cyano, —CONHR9, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, nitro, —CO—NR16R17, —O-alkNR12R13 and alkylthioalkyl, or a heteroaromatic radical selected from isoquinolyl, pyridyl, quinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolyl, 1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolyl and thienyl, these heteroaromatic radicals being unsubstituted or substituted with a halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, —COOR5, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethylsulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, —NR6R7, —CO—NH—NR6R7, cyano, —CONHR9, alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, nitro or alkylthioalkyl substituent;
R3 and R4, which may be identical or different, represent either an aromatic radical selected from phenyl and naphthyl, these aromatic radicals being nonsubstituted or substituted with one or more substituents selected from halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, —CONR10R11, -alk-NR6R7, hydroxyalkyl, formyl and —COOR5, or a heteroaromatic radical selected from thiazolyl and thienyl rings, these heteroaromatic rings being nonsubstituted or substituted by a halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, —CONR10R11, -alk-NR6R7, hydroxyalkyl or —COOR5;
R5 is alkyl or phenyl which is optionally substituted with one or more halogens;
R6 and R7, which may be identical or different, represent a hydrogen, alkyl, —COOalk, cycloalkyl, alkylcycloalkyl, alk-O-alk or hydroxyalkyl radical or, alternatively, R6 and R7, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk, —CO-alk-NR14R15, oxo, hydroxyalkyl, alk-O-alk or —CO—NH2 radicals;
R9 represents a hydrogen or unsubstituted alkyl radical or an alkyl radical substituted with dialkylamino, phenyl, cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with —COOalk) or a 3- to 10-membered saturated or unsaturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing one or more heteroatoms selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with one or more alkyl radicals;
R10 and R11, which may be identical or different, represent a hydrogen or alkyl radical or, alternatively, R10 and R11, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl radical;
R12 and R13, which may be identical or different, represent a hydrogen, alkyl or cycloalkyl radical or, alternatively, R12 and R13, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen and being optionally substituted with an alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 radical, or a 3- to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle containing a heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
R14 and R15, which may be identical or different, represent a hydrogen, alkyl or —COOalk radical;
R16 and R17, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a 3-to 10-membered saturated mono- or bicyclic heterocycle optionally containing another heteroatom selected from oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen;
alk represents an alkyl or alkylene radical,
it being understood that the alkyl and alkylene radicals and portions and the alkoxy radicals and portions are in the form of a straight or branched chain and contain 1 to 6 carbon atoms,
an optical isomer thereof or a salt thereof with an inorganic or organic acid.
9. The method of claim 1 wherein said compound is selected from:
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, 1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)]azetidin-3-ol,
3-acetoxy-1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylulfonyl)methyl)methylsulfonylmethyl-(RS)]azetidine, their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid.
10. The method of claim 1 wherein, in the compound of formula (I) according to claim 1,
R represents structure (A) or (B);
R′ representing a hydrogen or —COalk radical;
R1 represents a methyl or ethyl radical;
R2 represents either (I) an aromatic selected from naphthyl, phenyl, phenyl substituted with one or more halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, hydroxyl, —COOR5 (in which R5 represents an alkyl or phenyl radical optionally substituted with several halogens) trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethylsulfanyl, trifluoromethoxy, —NR6R7 (in which R6 and R7, which may be identical or different, represent a hydrogen, alkyl or —COOalk radical or, alternatively, R6 and R7, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a heterocycle selected from pyrrolidinyl, piperidyl, piperazinyl and piperazinyl substituted with one or more alkyl, —COalk, —COOalk, —CO—NHalk, —CS—NHalk or —CO-alk-NR14R15 radicals (in which R14 and R15, which may be identical or different, represent a hydrogen or alkyl radical), —CO—NH—NR6R7 (in which R6 and R7, which may be identical or different, represent a hydrogen or alkyl radical or, alternatively, R6 and R7, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a heterocycle selected from piperidyl, pyrrolyl, piperazinyl and piperazyl substituted with one or more alkyl radicals), cyano, —CONHR9 (in which R9 represents a hydrogen or unsubstituted alkyl radical or an alkyl radical substituted with dialkylamino, phenyl or cycloalkyl (optionally substituted with —COOalk)) or (II) a heterocycle selected from pyrrolidinyl (optionally substituted with alkyl), tetrahydrofuryl or morpholinyl), alkylsulfanyl, hydroxyalkyl, nitro, —CO—NR16R17, (in which R16 and R17, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a piperidyl ring), —O-alkNR12R13 (in which R12 and R13, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a morpholino ring) and alkylthioalkyl, or (III) a heteroaromatic selected from isoquinolyl, pyridyl, quinolyl,
1,2,3,4-tetrahydroisoquinolyl,
1,2,3,4-tetrahydroquinolyl,thienyl, and
thienyl substituted with a —COOR5 (in which R5 represents an alkyl radical) or —CONHR9, (in which R9 represents an alkyl radical);
R3 and R4, which may be identical or different, represent either (IV) an aromatic selected from
phenyl and phenyl substituted with one or more substituents selected from halogen, alkyl, alkoxy, trifluoromethyl, trifluoromethoxy, hydroxyalkyl, formyl, —COOR5 (in which R5 is an alkyl radical), —CONR10R11 (in which R10 and R11, which may be identical or different, represent a hydrogen or alkyl radical), -alk-NR6R7 (in which R6 and R7, which may be identical or different, represent a hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, -alk-O-alk or hydroxyalkyl radical or, alternatively, R6 and R7, together with the nitrogen atom to which they are attached, form a heterocycle selected from piperidyl (optionally substituted with alkyl or oxo), pyrrolidinyl (optionally substituted with alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, -alk-O-alk or —CO—NH2), thiomorpholinyl, morpholinyl, pyrrolyl, piperazinyl optionally substituted with oxo, alkyl, hydroxyalkyl, and —COOR5 (in which R5 is an alkyl radical), or (V) a heteroaromatic selected from thiazolyl and thienyl;
alk represents an alkyl or alkylene radical,
it being understood that the alkyl and alkylene radicals and portions and the alkoxy radicals and portions are in the form of a straight or branched chain and contain 1 to 6 carbon atoms, an optical isomer thereof or a salt thereof with an inorganic or organic acid.
11. The method of claim 1 wherein said compound is selected from:
1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-chlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,5-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(2,3-dichlorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-fluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-bromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-iodophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfonyl)(3-trifluoromethylphenyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-{[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)phenyl](methylsulfonyl)-methylene} azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3,5-dibromophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-carbamoylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(naphth-1-yl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-methoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-methylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
(RS)-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl]azetidine,
(R)-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl] azetidine,
(S)-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]-1-[(4-methoxyphenyl)(phenyl)methyl] azetidine,
1-[bis(4-trifluoromethoxyphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, and
1-[bis(4-trifluoromethylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine.
12. The method of claims 1, wherein said compound is selected from:
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3,5-bis(trifluoromethyl)-phenyl]methylsulfonylmethylene} azetidine,
(RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(R)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(S)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(2,4-dichlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
(RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
(R)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(S)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(hydroxymethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
(RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(pyrrolidylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(R)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(pyrrolidylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
(S)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(pyrrolidylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(3,3-dimethylpiperidin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(3,3-dimethylpiperidin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(3,3-dimethylpiperidin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(thiomorpholin-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(thiomorpholin-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(thiomorpholin-4-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethyl-N-cyclohexylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(R15)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethyl-N-cyclohexylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethyl-N-cyclohexylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, and
1-{{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl){4-[(4-ethoxycarbonylpiperazinyl)-methyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid.
13. The method of claim 1, wherein said compound is selected from:
1-{{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[(4-ethoxycarbonylpiperazinyl)-methyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[(4-ethoxycarbonylpiperazinyl)-methyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(N-cyclopropyl-N-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-cyclopropyl-N-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-cyclopropyl-N-propyl-aminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diisopropylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diisopropylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diisopropylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[bis-(2-methoxyethyl)aminomethyl]-phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl) {4-[bis-(2-methoxyethyl)aminomethyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl){4-[bis-(2-methoxyethyl)aminomethyl]phenyl}methyl}}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(di-n-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(di-n-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(di-n-propylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(piperidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperidin-1-ylmethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, and
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid.
14. The method of claim 1, wherein said compound is selected from:
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(4-methylpiperazin-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(morpholin-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(morpholin-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(morpholin-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(diethylaminomethyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperazin-2-on-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(piperazin-2-on-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl) [4-(piperazin-2-on-4-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-{(RS)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(imidazol-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(R)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(imidazol-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-{(S)-(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(imidazol-1-yl-methyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N,N-dimethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(R)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N,N-dimethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(S)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N,N-dimethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
(RS)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(R)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(S)-1-{(4-chlorophenyl)[4-(N-ethylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methyl}-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(RS)-1-[(4-carbamoylphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
(R)-1-[(4-carbamoylphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, and
(S)-1-[(4-carbamoylphenyl)(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine, their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid.
15. The method of claim 1, wherein said compound is selected from:
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-dichlorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(3-methylsulfanylmethyl)phenyl)]-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-cyanophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-carbamoylphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxyphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-hydroxyphenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)-(3-pyrrolidinylphenyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-hydroxymethyl-phenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]3-{(methylsulfonyl)[3-(N-piperidylcarbamoyl)phenyl]methylene} azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)-(3-trifluoromethylsulfanylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(2-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-[bis(3-fluorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
(RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene] azetidine,
(R)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine,
(S)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine,
(RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(R)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
(S)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-benzhydryl-3-[(ethylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{{3-[N-(4-methylpiperazinyl)carbamoyl]phenyl} (methylsulfonyl)methylene} azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-{[3-(2,2-dimethylcarbohydrazido)-phenyl](methylsulfonyl)methylene} azetidine,
1-[bis(thien-2-yl)methyl]-3-[3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)-methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(p-tolyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(phenyl)methylene] azetidine,
1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(4-hydroxymethylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methylaminophenyl)-(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(RS)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(R)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
(S)-1-[(4-chlorophenyl)(thiazol-2-yl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-methoxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methylene]azetidine, and
(RS)-1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-hydroxy-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(2-methoxycarbonylthien-5-yl)methyl]azetidine, their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid.
16. The method of claim 1, wherein said compound is selected from:
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(2-isobutylaminocarbonylthien-5-yl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(3-methoxycarbonylphenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)azetidin-3-ol,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(pyridin-4-yl)methyl-(RS)azetidin-3-ol,
1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-3-[(methylsulfonyl)(pyridin-3-yl)methyl-(RS)azetidin-3-ol,
3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-morpholin-4-yl-propyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-pyrrolidin-1-ylethyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-dimethylamino-1-methylethyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-piperidin-1-ylbenzamide,
3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-isobutylbenzamide,
3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(3-imidazol-1-ylpropyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-dimethylaminoethyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoic acid N′-methylhydrazide,
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-morpholin-4-ylethyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(1-ethylpyrrolidin-2-ylmethyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl] azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2,2-dimethylpropyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-cyclohexylmethylbenzamide, and
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-cyclopropylmethylbenzamide, their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid.
17. The method of claim 1, wherein said compound is selected from:
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-methylbutyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-phenylpropyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(tetrahydrofuran-2-ylmethyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2,2-diphenylethyl)benzamide,
3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}-methanesulfonylmethyl)-N-(2-ethylbutyl)benzamide,
4-{[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)benzoylamino]methyl}cyclohexanecarboxylic acid methyl ester,
2-amino-1-{4-[3-({1-[bis-(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]-azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}ethanone,
(2-{4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-oxoethyl)carbamic acid tert-butyl ester,
1-{4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-methylaminoethanone,
(2-{4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-oxoethyl)-N-methylcarbamic acid tert-butyl ester,
4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carbothioic acid N-methylamide,
4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid N-methylamide,
4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid methyl ester,
1-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]-4-isobutylpiperazine,
1-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]-4-ethylpiperazine,
4-acetyl 1-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene} methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine,
1-{4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazin-1-yl}-2-dimethylaminoethanone,
1-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine,
4-[3-({1-[bis(4-chlorophenyl)methyl]azetidin-3-ylidene}methanesulfonylmethyl)phenyl]piperazine-1-carboxylic acid tert-butyl ester,
1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methylene]azetidine,
3-acetoxy-1-[bis(4-methoxycarbonylphenyl)methyl]-3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)(methylsulfonyl)methyl-(RS)azetidine,
(RS)-4-[4-((4-chlorophenyl) {3-[(3,5-difluorophenyl)-methanesulfonylmethylene]azetidin-1-yl}methyl)benzyl]morpholine, and
4-(4-{3-[(1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-ylidene)methanesulfonylmethyl]phenoxy} butyl)morpholine,
4-(4-{3-[(1-benzhydrylazetidin-3-ylidene)methanesulfonylmethyl]phenoxy}propyl)morpholine, their optical isomers and their salts with an inorganic or organic acid.
US10/870,274 1998-09-11 2004-06-17 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them Abandoned US20040235816A1 (en)

Priority Applications (2)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US10/870,274 US20040235816A1 (en) 1998-09-11 2004-06-17 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them
US11/420,238 US20060270649A1 (en) 1998-09-11 2006-05-25 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them

Applications Claiming Priority (7)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
FR98/11342 1998-09-11
FR9811342A FR2783246B1 (en) 1998-09-11 1998-09-11 AZETIDINE DERIVATIVES, THEIR PREPARATION AND THE MEDICINES CONTAINING THEM
US11992999P 1999-02-12 1999-02-12
PCT/FR1999/002147 WO2000015609A1 (en) 1998-09-11 1999-09-09 Azetidine derivatives, preparation and medicines containing them
US09/803,723 US6518264B2 (en) 1998-09-11 2001-03-09 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them
US10/320,344 US6858603B2 (en) 1998-09-11 2002-12-16 Acetindine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them
US10/870,274 US20040235816A1 (en) 1998-09-11 2004-06-17 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US10/320,344 Continuation US6858603B2 (en) 1998-09-11 2002-12-16 Acetindine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/420,238 Continuation US20060270649A1 (en) 1998-09-11 2006-05-25 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20040235816A1 true US20040235816A1 (en) 2004-11-25

Family

ID=26234537

Family Applications (4)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US09/803,723 Expired - Fee Related US6518264B2 (en) 1998-09-11 2001-03-09 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them
US10/320,344 Expired - Fee Related US6858603B2 (en) 1998-09-11 2002-12-16 Acetindine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them
US10/870,274 Abandoned US20040235816A1 (en) 1998-09-11 2004-06-17 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them
US11/420,238 Abandoned US20060270649A1 (en) 1998-09-11 2006-05-25 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them

Family Applications Before (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US09/803,723 Expired - Fee Related US6518264B2 (en) 1998-09-11 2001-03-09 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them
US10/320,344 Expired - Fee Related US6858603B2 (en) 1998-09-11 2002-12-16 Acetindine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them

Family Applications After (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/420,238 Abandoned US20060270649A1 (en) 1998-09-11 2006-05-25 Azetidine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them

Country Status (5)

Country Link
US (4) US6518264B2 (en)
KR (1) KR100652994B1 (en)
AU (1) AU2004203078B2 (en)
IL (2) IL141769A0 (en)
NO (1) NO321480B1 (en)

Cited By (10)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20040266845A1 (en) * 2003-06-20 2004-12-30 Nettekoven Matthias Heinrich Benzothiazolyl derivatives
US20050054679A1 (en) * 2001-09-21 2005-03-10 Solvay Pharmaceuticals B.V. 1 H-imidazole derivatives having CB1 agonistic, CB1 partial agonistic or CB1-antagonistic activity
US20050165012A1 (en) * 2004-01-28 2005-07-28 Jean-Marc Plancher Spiro-pentacyclic compounds
US20050250769A1 (en) * 2004-05-10 2005-11-10 Alexander Mayweg Heterocyclic cannabinoid receptor antagonists
US20060089367A1 (en) * 2004-10-27 2006-04-27 Konrad Bleicher New indole or benzimidazole derivatives as CB1 inverse agonists
US20060100206A1 (en) * 2004-11-09 2006-05-11 Jean-Marc Plancher Heterocyclic CB1 receptor antagonists
US20060229326A1 (en) * 2005-04-06 2006-10-12 Paul Hebeisen Pyridine-3-carboxamide derivatives as CB1 inverse agonists
US20060293318A1 (en) * 2005-06-22 2006-12-28 Beat Frei Stereospecifically substituted benzo[1,3]dioxolyl derivatives
US8410107B2 (en) 2010-10-15 2013-04-02 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. N-pyridin-3-yl or N-pyrazin-2-yl carboxamides
US8669254B2 (en) 2010-12-15 2014-03-11 Hoffman-La Roche Inc. Pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine or pyrazine carboxamides as HDL-cholesterol raising agents

Families Citing this family (32)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
FR2814678B1 (en) 2000-10-04 2002-12-20 Aventis Pharma Sa COMBINATION OF AN ANTAGONIST OF THE CB1 RECEPTOR AND SIBUTRAMINE, THE PHARMACEUTICAL COMPOSITIONS CONTAINING THEM AND THEIR USE FOR THE TREATMENT OF OBESITY
US20020091114A1 (en) * 2000-10-04 2002-07-11 Odile Piot-Grosjean Combination of a CB1 receptor antagonist and of sibutramine, the pharmaceutical compositions comprising them and their use in the treatment of obesity
US20030139386A1 (en) * 2001-12-21 2003-07-24 Sophie Cote Pharmaceutical compositions based on azetidine derivatives
CA2502511A1 (en) * 2002-10-18 2004-05-29 Pfizer Products Inc. Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
US7129239B2 (en) * 2002-10-28 2006-10-31 Pfizer Inc. Purine compounds and uses thereof
US7247628B2 (en) * 2002-12-12 2007-07-24 Pfizer, Inc. Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
US7329658B2 (en) * 2003-02-06 2008-02-12 Pfizer Inc Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
US7176210B2 (en) * 2003-02-10 2007-02-13 Pfizer Inc. Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
US20040214856A1 (en) * 2003-04-23 2004-10-28 Pfizer Inc Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
US7268133B2 (en) * 2003-04-23 2007-09-11 Pfizer, Inc. Patent Department Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
US7145012B2 (en) 2003-04-23 2006-12-05 Pfizer Inc. Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
US7141669B2 (en) * 2003-04-23 2006-11-28 Pfizer Inc. Cannabiniod receptor ligands and uses thereof
EP1622876A1 (en) * 2003-05-07 2006-02-08 Pfizer Products Inc. Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
US7232823B2 (en) 2003-06-09 2007-06-19 Pfizer, Inc. Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
NZ543451A (en) * 2003-06-11 2008-08-29 Merck & Co Inc Substituted 3-alkyl and 3-alkenyl azetidine derivitives
US20040259887A1 (en) * 2003-06-18 2004-12-23 Pfizer Inc Cannabinoid receptor ligands and uses thereof
US7649002B2 (en) 2004-02-04 2010-01-19 Pfizer Inc (3,5-dimethylpiperidin-1yl)(4-phenylpyrrolidin-3-yl)methanone derivatives as MCR4 agonists
US7262318B2 (en) * 2004-03-10 2007-08-28 Pfizer, Inc. Substituted heteroaryl- and phenylsulfamoyl compounds
US20050288340A1 (en) * 2004-06-29 2005-12-29 Pfizer Inc Substituted heteroaryl- and phenylsulfamoyl compounds
PA8660701A1 (en) 2005-02-04 2006-09-22 Pfizer Prod Inc SMALL AGONISTS AND THEIR USES
CA2609783A1 (en) * 2005-05-27 2006-12-07 Pfizer Products Inc. Combination of a cannabinoid-1- receptor-antagonist and a microsomal triglyceride transfer protein inhibitor for treating obesity or mainataining weight loss
WO2007015162A1 (en) * 2005-08-04 2007-02-08 Pfizer Limited Piperidinoyl-pyrrolidine and piperidinoyl-piperidine compounds
US7741317B2 (en) 2005-10-21 2010-06-22 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company LXR modulators
US7888376B2 (en) 2005-11-23 2011-02-15 Bristol-Myers Squibb Company Heterocyclic CETP inhibitors
US7906652B2 (en) * 2005-11-28 2011-03-15 Merck Sharp & Dohme Corp. Heterocycle-substituted 3-alkyl azetidine derivatives
MEP6808A (en) * 2006-02-23 2010-02-10 Lundbeck & Co As H Melanocortin type 4 receptor agonist piperidinoylpyrrolidines
CN101583593A (en) 2006-11-13 2009-11-18 辉瑞产品公司 Diaryl, dipyridinyl and aryl-pyridinyl derivatives and uses thereof
JP5498168B2 (en) 2006-12-01 2014-05-21 ブリストル−マイヤーズ スクイブ カンパニー N-((3-Benzyl) -2,2- (bis-phenyl) -propan-1-amine derivatives as CETP inhibitors for the treatment of atherosclerosis and cardiovascular disease
ES2421920T3 (en) * 2008-08-06 2013-09-06 Pfizer Ltd Diazepine and diazocan compounds as MC4 agonists
WO2016054560A1 (en) * 2014-10-02 2016-04-07 Flatley Discovery Lab Isoxazole compounds and methods for the treatment of cystic fibrosis
US9585867B2 (en) 2015-08-06 2017-03-07 Charles Everett Ankner Cannabinod formulation for the sedation of a human or animal
US10232229B2 (en) * 2015-08-14 2019-03-19 James Douglas JENNINGS Ball collection device

Citations (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4133881A (en) * 1977-04-27 1979-01-09 A. H. Robins Company, Incorporated Azetidinyl acetonitrile and acetamide antiarrhythmia compositions and methods
US4242261A (en) * 1979-07-19 1980-12-30 A. H. Robins Company, Inc. Production of methylene-cycloamines

Family Cites Families (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4260606A (en) 1979-07-19 1981-04-07 A. H. Robins Company, Inc. 3-Methyleneazetidine derivatives

Patent Citations (2)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4133881A (en) * 1977-04-27 1979-01-09 A. H. Robins Company, Incorporated Azetidinyl acetonitrile and acetamide antiarrhythmia compositions and methods
US4242261A (en) * 1979-07-19 1980-12-30 A. H. Robins Company, Inc. Production of methylene-cycloamines

Cited By (20)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7109216B2 (en) 2001-09-21 2006-09-19 Solvay Pharmaceuticals B.V. 1H-imidazole derivatives having CB1 agonistic, CB1 partial agonistic or CB1-antagonistic activity
US20050054679A1 (en) * 2001-09-21 2005-03-10 Solvay Pharmaceuticals B.V. 1 H-imidazole derivatives having CB1 agonistic, CB1 partial agonistic or CB1-antagonistic activity
US20040266845A1 (en) * 2003-06-20 2004-12-30 Nettekoven Matthias Heinrich Benzothiazolyl derivatives
US20070021478A1 (en) * 2003-06-20 2007-01-25 Nettekoven Matthias H Benzothiazolyl derivatives
US20050165012A1 (en) * 2004-01-28 2005-07-28 Jean-Marc Plancher Spiro-pentacyclic compounds
US7144890B2 (en) 2004-01-28 2006-12-05 Hoffman-La Roche Inc. Spiro-pentacyclic compounds
US7563910B2 (en) 2004-05-10 2009-07-21 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Heterocyclic cannabinoid receptor antagonists
US20050250769A1 (en) * 2004-05-10 2005-11-10 Alexander Mayweg Heterocyclic cannabinoid receptor antagonists
US7384945B2 (en) 2004-10-27 2008-06-10 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Indole or benzimidazole derivatives as CB1 inverse agonists
US20060089367A1 (en) * 2004-10-27 2006-04-27 Konrad Bleicher New indole or benzimidazole derivatives as CB1 inverse agonists
US20080234290A1 (en) * 2004-10-27 2008-09-25 Konrad Bleicher New indole or benzimidazole derivatives as cb1 inverse agonists
US7786128B2 (en) 2004-10-27 2010-08-31 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Indole or benzimidazole derivatives as CB1 inverse agonists
US7220743B2 (en) 2004-11-09 2007-05-22 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Heterocyclic CB1 receptor antagonists
US20060100206A1 (en) * 2004-11-09 2006-05-11 Jean-Marc Plancher Heterocyclic CB1 receptor antagonists
US7229999B2 (en) 2005-04-06 2007-06-12 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. Pyridine-3-carboxamide derivatives as CB1 inverse agonists
US20060229326A1 (en) * 2005-04-06 2006-10-12 Paul Hebeisen Pyridine-3-carboxamide derivatives as CB1 inverse agonists
US20060293318A1 (en) * 2005-06-22 2006-12-28 Beat Frei Stereospecifically substituted benzo[1,3]dioxolyl derivatives
US20100056513A1 (en) * 2005-06-22 2010-03-04 Beat Frei Stereospecifically substituted benzo[1,3]dioxolyl derivatives
US8410107B2 (en) 2010-10-15 2013-04-02 Hoffmann-La Roche Inc. N-pyridin-3-yl or N-pyrazin-2-yl carboxamides
US8669254B2 (en) 2010-12-15 2014-03-11 Hoffman-La Roche Inc. Pyridine, pyridazine, pyrimidine or pyrazine carboxamides as HDL-cholesterol raising agents

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
NO20011216L (en) 2001-05-09
KR20010085774A (en) 2001-09-07
IL141769A0 (en) 2002-03-10
US6518264B2 (en) 2003-02-11
AU2004203078B2 (en) 2007-04-26
US20060270649A1 (en) 2006-11-30
IL141769A (en) 2008-11-26
US6858603B2 (en) 2005-02-22
KR100652994B1 (en) 2006-11-30
AU2004203078A1 (en) 2004-09-02
US20030162808A1 (en) 2003-08-28
NO321480B1 (en) 2006-05-15
US20020035102A1 (en) 2002-03-21
NO20011216D0 (en) 2001-03-09

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US6858603B2 (en) Acetindine derivatives, their preparation and medicaments containing them
AU772025B2 (en) Azetidine derivatives, preparation and medicines containing them
US6872717B2 (en) Pharmacological uses of azetidine derivatives
AU2001237525B2 (en) Azetidine derivatives, preparation thereof and pharmaceutical compositions containing same
US6734176B2 (en) Pharmaceutical compositions containing 3-aminoazetidine derivatives, novel derivatives and their preparation
US6355631B1 (en) Pharmaceutical compositions containing azetidine derivatives, novel azetidine derivatives and their preparation
MXPA01001927A (en) Azetidine derivatives, preparation and medicines containing them

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION